summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/build-aux
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorColin Watson <cjwatson@debian.org>2022-02-04 15:11:47 +0000
committerColin Watson <cjwatson@debian.org>2022-02-04 15:11:47 +0000
commit828b489c68a5a022c106656cfdff19bb9b584eec (patch)
tree7225919cd6e445d94080fa108a1a6b05fb890cf7 /build-aux
parenta2d4ffce13a855f29a63bac2099ebe0f5a4e50bd (diff)
parentbfe34108bc20e9d75e3f08bfc8305e4f4cd632a9 (diff)
Import man-db_2.10.0.orig.tar.xz
Diffstat (limited to 'build-aux')
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/ar-lib2
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/compile348
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/config.guess1184
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/config.rpath6
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/config.sub655
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/depcomp3
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/gitlog-to-changelog7
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/gnupload19
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/install-sh148
-rwxr-xr-x[-rw-r--r--]build-aux/ltmain.sh10
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/mdate-sh228
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/missing2
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/test-driver11
-rw-r--r--build-aux/texinfo.tex11707
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/ylwrap2
15 files changed, 1473 insertions, 12859 deletions
diff --git a/build-aux/ar-lib b/build-aux/ar-lib
index 1e9388e2..c349042c 100755
--- a/build-aux/ar-lib
+++ b/build-aux/ar-lib
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
me=ar-lib
scriptversion=2019-07-04.01; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 2010-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 2010-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# Written by Peter Rosin <peda@lysator.liu.se>.
#
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
diff --git a/build-aux/compile b/build-aux/compile
new file mode 100755
index 00000000..df363c8f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/compile
@@ -0,0 +1,348 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# Wrapper for compilers which do not understand '-c -o'.
+
+scriptversion=2018-03-07.03; # UTC
+
+# Copyright (C) 1999-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Written by Tom Tromey <tromey@cygnus.com>.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
+# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
+# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
+
+# This file is maintained in Automake, please report
+# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
+# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+
+nl='
+'
+
+# We need space, tab and new line, in precisely that order. Quoting is
+# there to prevent tools from complaining about whitespace usage.
+IFS=" "" $nl"
+
+file_conv=
+
+# func_file_conv build_file lazy
+# Convert a $build file to $host form and store it in $file
+# Currently only supports Windows hosts. If the determined conversion
+# type is listed in (the comma separated) LAZY, no conversion will
+# take place.
+func_file_conv ()
+{
+ file=$1
+ case $file in
+ / | /[!/]*) # absolute file, and not a UNC file
+ if test -z "$file_conv"; then
+ # lazily determine how to convert abs files
+ case `uname -s` in
+ MINGW*)
+ file_conv=mingw
+ ;;
+ CYGWIN* | MSYS*)
+ file_conv=cygwin
+ ;;
+ *)
+ file_conv=wine
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ case $file_conv/,$2, in
+ *,$file_conv,*)
+ ;;
+ mingw/*)
+ file=`cmd //C echo "$file " | sed -e 's/"\(.*\) " *$/\1/'`
+ ;;
+ cygwin/* | msys/*)
+ file=`cygpath -m "$file" || echo "$file"`
+ ;;
+ wine/*)
+ file=`winepath -w "$file" || echo "$file"`
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+}
+
+# func_cl_dashL linkdir
+# Make cl look for libraries in LINKDIR
+func_cl_dashL ()
+{
+ func_file_conv "$1"
+ if test -z "$lib_path"; then
+ lib_path=$file
+ else
+ lib_path="$lib_path;$file"
+ fi
+ linker_opts="$linker_opts -LIBPATH:$file"
+}
+
+# func_cl_dashl library
+# Do a library search-path lookup for cl
+func_cl_dashl ()
+{
+ lib=$1
+ found=no
+ save_IFS=$IFS
+ IFS=';'
+ for dir in $lib_path $LIB
+ do
+ IFS=$save_IFS
+ if $shared && test -f "$dir/$lib.dll.lib"; then
+ found=yes
+ lib=$dir/$lib.dll.lib
+ break
+ fi
+ if test -f "$dir/$lib.lib"; then
+ found=yes
+ lib=$dir/$lib.lib
+ break
+ fi
+ if test -f "$dir/lib$lib.a"; then
+ found=yes
+ lib=$dir/lib$lib.a
+ break
+ fi
+ done
+ IFS=$save_IFS
+
+ if test "$found" != yes; then
+ lib=$lib.lib
+ fi
+}
+
+# func_cl_wrapper cl arg...
+# Adjust compile command to suit cl
+func_cl_wrapper ()
+{
+ # Assume a capable shell
+ lib_path=
+ shared=:
+ linker_opts=
+ for arg
+ do
+ if test -n "$eat"; then
+ eat=
+ else
+ case $1 in
+ -o)
+ # configure might choose to run compile as 'compile cc -o foo foo.c'.
+ eat=1
+ case $2 in
+ *.o | *.[oO][bB][jJ])
+ func_file_conv "$2"
+ set x "$@" -Fo"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ func_file_conv "$2"
+ set x "$@" -Fe"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ -I)
+ eat=1
+ func_file_conv "$2" mingw
+ set x "$@" -I"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ -I*)
+ func_file_conv "${1#-I}" mingw
+ set x "$@" -I"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ -l)
+ eat=1
+ func_cl_dashl "$2"
+ set x "$@" "$lib"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ -l*)
+ func_cl_dashl "${1#-l}"
+ set x "$@" "$lib"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ -L)
+ eat=1
+ func_cl_dashL "$2"
+ ;;
+ -L*)
+ func_cl_dashL "${1#-L}"
+ ;;
+ -static)
+ shared=false
+ ;;
+ -Wl,*)
+ arg=${1#-Wl,}
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS=','
+ for flag in $arg; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ linker_opts="$linker_opts $flag"
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ ;;
+ -Xlinker)
+ eat=1
+ linker_opts="$linker_opts $2"
+ ;;
+ -*)
+ set x "$@" "$1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *.cc | *.CC | *.cxx | *.CXX | *.[cC]++)
+ func_file_conv "$1"
+ set x "$@" -Tp"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *.c | *.cpp | *.CPP | *.lib | *.LIB | *.Lib | *.OBJ | *.obj | *.[oO])
+ func_file_conv "$1" mingw
+ set x "$@" "$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set x "$@" "$1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ shift
+ done
+ if test -n "$linker_opts"; then
+ linker_opts="-link$linker_opts"
+ fi
+ exec "$@" $linker_opts
+ exit 1
+}
+
+eat=
+
+case $1 in
+ '')
+ echo "$0: No command. Try '$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
+ exit 1;
+ ;;
+ -h | --h*)
+ cat <<\EOF
+Usage: compile [--help] [--version] PROGRAM [ARGS]
+
+Wrapper for compilers which do not understand '-c -o'.
+Remove '-o dest.o' from ARGS, run PROGRAM with the remaining
+arguments, and rename the output as expected.
+
+If you are trying to build a whole package this is not the
+right script to run: please start by reading the file 'INSTALL'.
+
+Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>.
+EOF
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ -v | --v*)
+ echo "compile $scriptversion"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ cl | *[/\\]cl | cl.exe | *[/\\]cl.exe | \
+ icl | *[/\\]icl | icl.exe | *[/\\]icl.exe )
+ func_cl_wrapper "$@" # Doesn't return...
+ ;;
+esac
+
+ofile=
+cfile=
+
+for arg
+do
+ if test -n "$eat"; then
+ eat=
+ else
+ case $1 in
+ -o)
+ # configure might choose to run compile as 'compile cc -o foo foo.c'.
+ # So we strip '-o arg' only if arg is an object.
+ eat=1
+ case $2 in
+ *.o | *.obj)
+ ofile=$2
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set x "$@" -o "$2"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ *.c)
+ cfile=$1
+ set x "$@" "$1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set x "$@" "$1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ shift
+done
+
+if test -z "$ofile" || test -z "$cfile"; then
+ # If no '-o' option was seen then we might have been invoked from a
+ # pattern rule where we don't need one. That is ok -- this is a
+ # normal compilation that the losing compiler can handle. If no
+ # '.c' file was seen then we are probably linking. That is also
+ # ok.
+ exec "$@"
+fi
+
+# Name of file we expect compiler to create.
+cofile=`echo "$cfile" | sed 's|^.*[\\/]||; s|^[a-zA-Z]:||; s/\.c$/.o/'`
+
+# Create the lock directory.
+# Note: use '[/\\:.-]' here to ensure that we don't use the same name
+# that we are using for the .o file. Also, base the name on the expected
+# object file name, since that is what matters with a parallel build.
+lockdir=`echo "$cofile" | sed -e 's|[/\\:.-]|_|g'`.d
+while true; do
+ if mkdir "$lockdir" >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ break
+ fi
+ sleep 1
+done
+# FIXME: race condition here if user kills between mkdir and trap.
+trap "rmdir '$lockdir'; exit 1" 1 2 15
+
+# Run the compile.
+"$@"
+ret=$?
+
+if test -f "$cofile"; then
+ test "$cofile" = "$ofile" || mv "$cofile" "$ofile"
+elif test -f "${cofile}bj"; then
+ test "${cofile}bj" = "$ofile" || mv "${cofile}bj" "$ofile"
+fi
+
+rmdir "$lockdir"
+exit $ret
+
+# Local Variables:
+# mode: shell-script
+# sh-indentation: 2
+# eval: (add-hook 'before-save-hook 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/config.guess b/build-aux/config.guess
index 11fda528..7f76b622 100755
--- a/build-aux/config.guess
+++ b/build-aux/config.guess
@@ -1,12 +1,14 @@
#! /bin/sh
# Attempt to guess a canonical system name.
-# Copyright 1992-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright 1992-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-timestamp='2020-04-26'
+# shellcheck disable=SC2006,SC2268 # see below for rationale
+
+timestamp='2022-01-09'
# This file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
# under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
+# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
# (at your option) any later version.
#
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
@@ -27,11 +29,19 @@ timestamp='2020-04-26'
# Originally written by Per Bothner; maintained since 2000 by Ben Elliston.
#
# You can get the latest version of this script from:
-# https://git.savannah.gnu.org/gitweb/?p=config.git;a=blob_plain;f=config.guess
+# https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/config.git/plain/config.guess
#
# Please send patches to <config-patches@gnu.org>.
+# The "shellcheck disable" line above the timestamp inhibits complaints
+# about features and limitations of the classic Bourne shell that were
+# superseded or lifted in POSIX. However, this script identifies a wide
+# variety of pre-POSIX systems that do not have POSIX shells at all, and
+# even some reasonably current systems (Solaris 10 as case-in-point) still
+# have a pre-POSIX /bin/sh.
+
+
me=`echo "$0" | sed -e 's,.*/,,'`
usage="\
@@ -50,7 +60,7 @@ version="\
GNU config.guess ($timestamp)
Originally written by Per Bothner.
-Copyright 1992-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+Copyright 1992-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This is free software; see the source for copying conditions. There is NO
warranty; not even for MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE."
@@ -84,6 +94,9 @@ if test $# != 0; then
exit 1
fi
+# Just in case it came from the environment.
+GUESS=
+
# CC_FOR_BUILD -- compiler used by this script. Note that the use of a
# compiler to aid in system detection is discouraged as it requires
# temporary files to be created and, as you can see below, it is a
@@ -102,7 +115,7 @@ set_cc_for_build() {
# prevent multiple calls if $tmp is already set
test "$tmp" && return 0
: "${TMPDIR=/tmp}"
- # shellcheck disable=SC2039
+ # shellcheck disable=SC2039,SC3028
{ tmp=`(umask 077 && mktemp -d "$TMPDIR/cgXXXXXX") 2>/dev/null` && test -n "$tmp" && test -d "$tmp" ; } ||
{ test -n "$RANDOM" && tmp=$TMPDIR/cg$$-$RANDOM && (umask 077 && mkdir "$tmp" 2>/dev/null) ; } ||
{ tmp=$TMPDIR/cg-$$ && (umask 077 && mkdir "$tmp" 2>/dev/null) && echo "Warning: creating insecure temp directory" >&2 ; } ||
@@ -112,7 +125,7 @@ set_cc_for_build() {
,,) echo "int x;" > "$dummy.c"
for driver in cc gcc c89 c99 ; do
if ($driver -c -o "$dummy.o" "$dummy.c") >/dev/null 2>&1 ; then
- CC_FOR_BUILD="$driver"
+ CC_FOR_BUILD=$driver
break
fi
done
@@ -133,14 +146,12 @@ fi
UNAME_MACHINE=`(uname -m) 2>/dev/null` || UNAME_MACHINE=unknown
UNAME_RELEASE=`(uname -r) 2>/dev/null` || UNAME_RELEASE=unknown
-UNAME_SYSTEM=`(uname -s) 2>/dev/null` || UNAME_SYSTEM=unknown
+UNAME_SYSTEM=`(uname -s) 2>/dev/null` || UNAME_SYSTEM=unknown
UNAME_VERSION=`(uname -v) 2>/dev/null` || UNAME_VERSION=unknown
-case "$UNAME_SYSTEM" in
+case $UNAME_SYSTEM in
Linux|GNU|GNU/*)
- # If the system lacks a compiler, then just pick glibc.
- # We could probably try harder.
- LIBC=gnu
+ LIBC=unknown
set_cc_for_build
cat <<-EOF > "$dummy.c"
@@ -149,24 +160,37 @@ Linux|GNU|GNU/*)
LIBC=uclibc
#elif defined(__dietlibc__)
LIBC=dietlibc
- #else
+ #elif defined(__GLIBC__)
LIBC=gnu
+ #else
+ #include <stdarg.h>
+ /* First heuristic to detect musl libc. */
+ #ifdef __DEFINED_va_list
+ LIBC=musl
+ #endif
#endif
EOF
- eval "`$CC_FOR_BUILD -E "$dummy.c" 2>/dev/null | grep '^LIBC' | sed 's, ,,g'`"
+ cc_set_libc=`$CC_FOR_BUILD -E "$dummy.c" 2>/dev/null | grep '^LIBC' | sed 's, ,,g'`
+ eval "$cc_set_libc"
- # If ldd exists, use it to detect musl libc.
- if command -v ldd >/dev/null && \
- ldd --version 2>&1 | grep -q ^musl
- then
- LIBC=musl
+ # Second heuristic to detect musl libc.
+ if [ "$LIBC" = unknown ] &&
+ command -v ldd >/dev/null &&
+ ldd --version 2>&1 | grep -q ^musl; then
+ LIBC=musl
+ fi
+
+ # If the system lacks a compiler, then just pick glibc.
+ # We could probably try harder.
+ if [ "$LIBC" = unknown ]; then
+ LIBC=gnu
fi
;;
esac
# Note: order is significant - the case branches are not exclusive.
-case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
+case $UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION in
*:NetBSD:*:*)
# NetBSD (nbsd) targets should (where applicable) match one or
# more of the tuples: *-*-netbsdelf*, *-*-netbsdaout*,
@@ -178,12 +202,12 @@ case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
#
# Note: NetBSD doesn't particularly care about the vendor
# portion of the name. We always set it to "unknown".
- sysctl="sysctl -n hw.machine_arch"
UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`(uname -p 2>/dev/null || \
- "/sbin/$sysctl" 2>/dev/null || \
- "/usr/sbin/$sysctl" 2>/dev/null || \
+ /sbin/sysctl -n hw.machine_arch 2>/dev/null || \
+ /usr/sbin/sysctl -n hw.machine_arch 2>/dev/null || \
echo unknown)`
- case "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH" in
+ case $UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH in
+ aarch64eb) machine=aarch64_be-unknown ;;
armeb) machine=armeb-unknown ;;
arm*) machine=arm-unknown ;;
sh3el) machine=shl-unknown ;;
@@ -192,13 +216,13 @@ case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
earmv*)
arch=`echo "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH" | sed -e 's,^e\(armv[0-9]\).*$,\1,'`
endian=`echo "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH" | sed -ne 's,^.*\(eb\)$,\1,p'`
- machine="${arch}${endian}"-unknown
+ machine=${arch}${endian}-unknown
;;
- *) machine="$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH"-unknown ;;
+ *) machine=$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH-unknown ;;
esac
# The Operating System including object format, if it has switched
# to ELF recently (or will in the future) and ABI.
- case "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH" in
+ case $UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH in
earm*)
os=netbsdelf
;;
@@ -219,7 +243,7 @@ case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
;;
esac
# Determine ABI tags.
- case "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH" in
+ case $UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH in
earm*)
expr='s/^earmv[0-9]/-eabi/;s/eb$//'
abi=`echo "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH" | sed -e "$expr"`
@@ -230,7 +254,7 @@ case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
# thus, need a distinct triplet. However, they do not need
# kernel version information, so it can be replaced with a
# suitable tag, in the style of linux-gnu.
- case "$UNAME_VERSION" in
+ case $UNAME_VERSION in
Debian*)
release='-gnu'
;;
@@ -241,51 +265,57 @@ case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
# Since CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM:
# contains redundant information, the shorter form:
# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-OPERATING_SYSTEM is used.
- echo "$machine-${os}${release}${abi-}"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$machine-${os}${release}${abi-}
+ ;;
*:Bitrig:*:*)
UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`arch | sed 's/Bitrig.//'`
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH"-unknown-bitrig"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH-unknown-bitrig$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:OpenBSD:*:*)
UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`arch | sed 's/OpenBSD.//'`
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH"-unknown-openbsd"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH-unknown-openbsd$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
+ *:SecBSD:*:*)
+ UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`arch | sed 's/SecBSD.//'`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH-unknown-secbsd$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:LibertyBSD:*:*)
UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`arch | sed 's/^.*BSD\.//'`
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH"-unknown-libertybsd"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH-unknown-libertybsd$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:MidnightBSD:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-midnightbsd"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-midnightbsd$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:ekkoBSD:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-ekkobsd"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-ekkobsd$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:SolidBSD:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-solidbsd"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-solidbsd$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:OS108:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-os108_"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-os108_$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
macppc:MirBSD:*:*)
- echo powerpc-unknown-mirbsd"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-unknown-mirbsd$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:MirBSD:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-mirbsd"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-mirbsd$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:Sortix:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-sortix
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-sortix
+ ;;
*:Twizzler:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-twizzler
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-twizzler
+ ;;
*:Redox:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-redox
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-redox
+ ;;
mips:OSF1:*.*)
- echo mips-dec-osf1
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-dec-osf1
+ ;;
alpha:OSF1:*:*)
+ # Reset EXIT trap before exiting to avoid spurious non-zero exit code.
+ trap '' 0
case $UNAME_RELEASE in
*4.0)
UNAME_RELEASE=`/usr/sbin/sizer -v | awk '{print $3}'`
@@ -299,7 +329,7 @@ case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
# covers most systems running today. This code pipes the CPU
# types through head -n 1, so we only detect the type of CPU 0.
ALPHA_CPU_TYPE=`/usr/sbin/psrinfo -v | sed -n -e 's/^ The alpha \(.*\) processor.*$/\1/p' | head -n 1`
- case "$ALPHA_CPU_TYPE" in
+ case $ALPHA_CPU_TYPE in
"EV4 (21064)")
UNAME_MACHINE=alpha ;;
"EV4.5 (21064)")
@@ -336,117 +366,121 @@ case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
# A Tn.n version is a released field test version.
# A Xn.n version is an unreleased experimental baselevel.
# 1.2 uses "1.2" for uname -r.
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-dec-osf"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/^[PVTX]//' | tr ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz`"
- # Reset EXIT trap before exiting to avoid spurious non-zero exit code.
- exitcode=$?
- trap '' 0
- exit $exitcode ;;
+ OSF_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/^[PVTX]//' | tr ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-dec-osf$OSF_REL
+ ;;
Amiga*:UNIX_System_V:4.0:*)
- echo m68k-unknown-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-unknown-sysv4
+ ;;
*:[Aa]miga[Oo][Ss]:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-amigaos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-amigaos
+ ;;
*:[Mm]orph[Oo][Ss]:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-morphos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-morphos
+ ;;
*:OS/390:*:*)
- echo i370-ibm-openedition
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i370-ibm-openedition
+ ;;
*:z/VM:*:*)
- echo s390-ibm-zvmoe
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=s390-ibm-zvmoe
+ ;;
*:OS400:*:*)
- echo powerpc-ibm-os400
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-ibm-os400
+ ;;
arm:RISC*:1.[012]*:*|arm:riscix:1.[012]*:*)
- echo arm-acorn-riscix"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=arm-acorn-riscix$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
arm*:riscos:*:*|arm*:RISCOS:*:*)
- echo arm-unknown-riscos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=arm-unknown-riscos
+ ;;
SR2?01:HI-UX/MPP:*:* | SR8000:HI-UX/MPP:*:*)
- echo hppa1.1-hitachi-hiuxmpp
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.1-hitachi-hiuxmpp
+ ;;
Pyramid*:OSx*:*:* | MIS*:OSx*:*:* | MIS*:SMP_DC-OSx*:*:*)
# akee@wpdis03.wpafb.af.mil (Earle F. Ake) contributed MIS and NILE.
- if test "`(/bin/universe) 2>/dev/null`" = att ; then
- echo pyramid-pyramid-sysv3
- else
- echo pyramid-pyramid-bsd
- fi
- exit ;;
+ case `(/bin/universe) 2>/dev/null` in
+ att) GUESS=pyramid-pyramid-sysv3 ;;
+ *) GUESS=pyramid-pyramid-bsd ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
NILE*:*:*:dcosx)
- echo pyramid-pyramid-svr4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=pyramid-pyramid-svr4
+ ;;
DRS?6000:unix:4.0:6*)
- echo sparc-icl-nx6
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sparc-icl-nx6
+ ;;
DRS?6000:UNIX_SV:4.2*:7* | DRS?6000:isis:4.2*:7*)
case `/usr/bin/uname -p` in
- sparc) echo sparc-icl-nx7; exit ;;
- esac ;;
+ sparc) GUESS=sparc-icl-nx7 ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
s390x:SunOS:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-ibm-solaris2"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`"
- exit ;;
+ SUN_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-ibm-solaris2$SUN_REL
+ ;;
sun4H:SunOS:5.*:*)
- echo sparc-hal-solaris2"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`"
- exit ;;
+ SUN_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
+ GUESS=sparc-hal-solaris2$SUN_REL
+ ;;
sun4*:SunOS:5.*:* | tadpole*:SunOS:5.*:*)
- echo sparc-sun-solaris2"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`"
- exit ;;
+ SUN_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
+ GUESS=sparc-sun-solaris2$SUN_REL
+ ;;
i86pc:AuroraUX:5.*:* | i86xen:AuroraUX:5.*:*)
- echo i386-pc-auroraux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i386-pc-auroraux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
i86pc:SunOS:5.*:* | i86xen:SunOS:5.*:*)
set_cc_for_build
SUN_ARCH=i386
# If there is a compiler, see if it is configured for 64-bit objects.
# Note that the Sun cc does not turn __LP64__ into 1 like gcc does.
# This test works for both compilers.
- if [ "$CC_FOR_BUILD" != no_compiler_found ]; then
+ if test "$CC_FOR_BUILD" != no_compiler_found; then
if (echo '#ifdef __amd64'; echo IS_64BIT_ARCH; echo '#endif') | \
- (CCOPTS="" $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null) | \
+ (CCOPTS="" $CC_FOR_BUILD -m64 -E - 2>/dev/null) | \
grep IS_64BIT_ARCH >/dev/null
then
SUN_ARCH=x86_64
fi
fi
- echo "$SUN_ARCH"-pc-solaris2"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`"
- exit ;;
+ SUN_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
+ GUESS=$SUN_ARCH-pc-solaris2$SUN_REL
+ ;;
sun4*:SunOS:6*:*)
# According to config.sub, this is the proper way to canonicalize
# SunOS6. Hard to guess exactly what SunOS6 will be like, but
# it's likely to be more like Solaris than SunOS4.
- echo sparc-sun-solaris3"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`"
- exit ;;
+ SUN_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
+ GUESS=sparc-sun-solaris3$SUN_REL
+ ;;
sun4*:SunOS:*:*)
- case "`/usr/bin/arch -k`" in
+ case `/usr/bin/arch -k` in
Series*|S4*)
UNAME_RELEASE=`uname -v`
;;
esac
# Japanese Language versions have a version number like `4.1.3-JL'.
- echo sparc-sun-sunos"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/-/_/'`"
- exit ;;
+ SUN_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/-/_/'`
+ GUESS=sparc-sun-sunos$SUN_REL
+ ;;
sun3*:SunOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-sun-sunos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-sun-sunos$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
sun*:*:4.2BSD:*)
UNAME_RELEASE=`(sed 1q /etc/motd | awk '{print substr($5,1,3)}') 2>/dev/null`
test "x$UNAME_RELEASE" = x && UNAME_RELEASE=3
- case "`/bin/arch`" in
+ case `/bin/arch` in
sun3)
- echo m68k-sun-sunos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ GUESS=m68k-sun-sunos$UNAME_RELEASE
;;
sun4)
- echo sparc-sun-sunos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ GUESS=sparc-sun-sunos$UNAME_RELEASE
;;
esac
- exit ;;
+ ;;
aushp:SunOS:*:*)
- echo sparc-auspex-sunos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sparc-auspex-sunos$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
# The situation for MiNT is a little confusing. The machine name
# can be virtually everything (everything which is not
# "atarist" or "atariste" at least should have a processor
@@ -456,41 +490,41 @@ case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM:$UNAME_RELEASE:$UNAME_VERSION" in
# MiNT. But MiNT is downward compatible to TOS, so this should
# be no problem.
atarist[e]:*MiNT:*:* | atarist[e]:*mint:*:* | atarist[e]:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-atari-mint"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-atari-mint$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
atari*:*MiNT:*:* | atari*:*mint:*:* | atarist[e]:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-atari-mint"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-atari-mint$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*falcon*:*MiNT:*:* | *falcon*:*mint:*:* | *falcon*:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-atari-mint"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-atari-mint$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
milan*:*MiNT:*:* | milan*:*mint:*:* | *milan*:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-milan-mint"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-milan-mint$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
hades*:*MiNT:*:* | hades*:*mint:*:* | *hades*:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-hades-mint"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-hades-mint$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:*MiNT:*:* | *:*mint:*:* | *:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-unknown-mint"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-unknown-mint$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
m68k:machten:*:*)
- echo m68k-apple-machten"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-apple-machten$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
powerpc:machten:*:*)
- echo powerpc-apple-machten"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-apple-machten$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
RISC*:Mach:*:*)
- echo mips-dec-mach_bsd4.3
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-dec-mach_bsd4.3
+ ;;
RISC*:ULTRIX:*:*)
- echo mips-dec-ultrix"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-dec-ultrix$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
VAX*:ULTRIX*:*:*)
- echo vax-dec-ultrix"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=vax-dec-ultrix$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
2020:CLIX:*:* | 2430:CLIX:*:*)
- echo clipper-intergraph-clix"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=clipper-intergraph-clix$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
mips:*:*:UMIPS | mips:*:*:RISCos)
set_cc_for_build
sed 's/^ //' << EOF > "$dummy.c"
@@ -518,75 +552,76 @@ EOF
dummyarg=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -n 's/\([0-9]*\).*/\1/p'` &&
SYSTEM_NAME=`"$dummy" "$dummyarg"` &&
{ echo "$SYSTEM_NAME"; exit; }
- echo mips-mips-riscos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-mips-riscos$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
Motorola:PowerMAX_OS:*:*)
- echo powerpc-motorola-powermax
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-motorola-powermax
+ ;;
Motorola:*:4.3:PL8-*)
- echo powerpc-harris-powermax
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-harris-powermax
+ ;;
Night_Hawk:*:*:PowerMAX_OS | Synergy:PowerMAX_OS:*:*)
- echo powerpc-harris-powermax
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-harris-powermax
+ ;;
Night_Hawk:Power_UNIX:*:*)
- echo powerpc-harris-powerunix
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-harris-powerunix
+ ;;
m88k:CX/UX:7*:*)
- echo m88k-harris-cxux7
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m88k-harris-cxux7
+ ;;
m88k:*:4*:R4*)
- echo m88k-motorola-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m88k-motorola-sysv4
+ ;;
m88k:*:3*:R3*)
- echo m88k-motorola-sysv3
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m88k-motorola-sysv3
+ ;;
AViiON:dgux:*:*)
# DG/UX returns AViiON for all architectures
UNAME_PROCESSOR=`/usr/bin/uname -p`
- if [ "$UNAME_PROCESSOR" = mc88100 ] || [ "$UNAME_PROCESSOR" = mc88110 ]
+ if test "$UNAME_PROCESSOR" = mc88100 || test "$UNAME_PROCESSOR" = mc88110
then
- if [ "$TARGET_BINARY_INTERFACE"x = m88kdguxelfx ] || \
- [ "$TARGET_BINARY_INTERFACE"x = x ]
+ if test "$TARGET_BINARY_INTERFACE"x = m88kdguxelfx || \
+ test "$TARGET_BINARY_INTERFACE"x = x
then
- echo m88k-dg-dgux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ GUESS=m88k-dg-dgux$UNAME_RELEASE
else
- echo m88k-dg-dguxbcs"$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ GUESS=m88k-dg-dguxbcs$UNAME_RELEASE
fi
else
- echo i586-dg-dgux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ GUESS=i586-dg-dgux$UNAME_RELEASE
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
M88*:DolphinOS:*:*) # DolphinOS (SVR3)
- echo m88k-dolphin-sysv3
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m88k-dolphin-sysv3
+ ;;
M88*:*:R3*:*)
# Delta 88k system running SVR3
- echo m88k-motorola-sysv3
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m88k-motorola-sysv3
+ ;;
XD88*:*:*:*) # Tektronix XD88 system running UTekV (SVR3)
- echo m88k-tektronix-sysv3
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m88k-tektronix-sysv3
+ ;;
Tek43[0-9][0-9]:UTek:*:*) # Tektronix 4300 system running UTek (BSD)
- echo m68k-tektronix-bsd
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-tektronix-bsd
+ ;;
*:IRIX*:*:*)
- echo mips-sgi-irix"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/-/_/g'`"
- exit ;;
+ IRIX_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/-/_/g'`
+ GUESS=mips-sgi-irix$IRIX_REL
+ ;;
????????:AIX?:[12].1:2) # AIX 2.2.1 or AIX 2.1.1 is RT/PC AIX.
- echo romp-ibm-aix # uname -m gives an 8 hex-code CPU id
- exit ;; # Note that: echo "'`uname -s`'" gives 'AIX '
+ GUESS=romp-ibm-aix # uname -m gives an 8 hex-code CPU id
+ ;; # Note that: echo "'`uname -s`'" gives 'AIX '
i*86:AIX:*:*)
- echo i386-ibm-aix
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i386-ibm-aix
+ ;;
ia64:AIX:*:*)
- if [ -x /usr/bin/oslevel ] ; then
+ if test -x /usr/bin/oslevel ; then
IBM_REV=`/usr/bin/oslevel`
else
- IBM_REV="$UNAME_VERSION.$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ IBM_REV=$UNAME_VERSION.$UNAME_RELEASE
fi
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-ibm-aix"$IBM_REV"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-ibm-aix$IBM_REV
+ ;;
*:AIX:2:3)
if grep bos325 /usr/include/stdio.h >/dev/null 2>&1; then
set_cc_for_build
@@ -603,16 +638,16 @@ EOF
EOF
if $CC_FOR_BUILD -o "$dummy" "$dummy.c" && SYSTEM_NAME=`"$dummy"`
then
- echo "$SYSTEM_NAME"
+ GUESS=$SYSTEM_NAME
else
- echo rs6000-ibm-aix3.2.5
+ GUESS=rs6000-ibm-aix3.2.5
fi
elif grep bos324 /usr/include/stdio.h >/dev/null 2>&1; then
- echo rs6000-ibm-aix3.2.4
+ GUESS=rs6000-ibm-aix3.2.4
else
- echo rs6000-ibm-aix3.2
+ GUESS=rs6000-ibm-aix3.2
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
*:AIX:*:[4567])
IBM_CPU_ID=`/usr/sbin/lsdev -C -c processor -S available | sed 1q | awk '{ print $1 }'`
if /usr/sbin/lsattr -El "$IBM_CPU_ID" | grep ' POWER' >/dev/null 2>&1; then
@@ -620,56 +655,56 @@ EOF
else
IBM_ARCH=powerpc
fi
- if [ -x /usr/bin/lslpp ] ; then
- IBM_REV=`/usr/bin/lslpp -Lqc bos.rte.libc |
+ if test -x /usr/bin/lslpp ; then
+ IBM_REV=`/usr/bin/lslpp -Lqc bos.rte.libc | \
awk -F: '{ print $3 }' | sed s/[0-9]*$/0/`
else
- IBM_REV="$UNAME_VERSION.$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ IBM_REV=$UNAME_VERSION.$UNAME_RELEASE
fi
- echo "$IBM_ARCH"-ibm-aix"$IBM_REV"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$IBM_ARCH-ibm-aix$IBM_REV
+ ;;
*:AIX:*:*)
- echo rs6000-ibm-aix
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=rs6000-ibm-aix
+ ;;
ibmrt:4.4BSD:*|romp-ibm:4.4BSD:*)
- echo romp-ibm-bsd4.4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=romp-ibm-bsd4.4
+ ;;
ibmrt:*BSD:*|romp-ibm:BSD:*) # covers RT/PC BSD and
- echo romp-ibm-bsd"$UNAME_RELEASE" # 4.3 with uname added to
- exit ;; # report: romp-ibm BSD 4.3
+ GUESS=romp-ibm-bsd$UNAME_RELEASE # 4.3 with uname added to
+ ;; # report: romp-ibm BSD 4.3
*:BOSX:*:*)
- echo rs6000-bull-bosx
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=rs6000-bull-bosx
+ ;;
DPX/2?00:B.O.S.:*:*)
- echo m68k-bull-sysv3
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-bull-sysv3
+ ;;
9000/[34]??:4.3bsd:1.*:*)
- echo m68k-hp-bsd
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-hp-bsd
+ ;;
hp300:4.4BSD:*:* | 9000/[34]??:4.3bsd:2.*:*)
- echo m68k-hp-bsd4.4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-hp-bsd4.4
+ ;;
9000/[34678]??:HP-UX:*:*)
- HPUX_REV=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[^.]*.[0B]*//'`
- case "$UNAME_MACHINE" in
+ HPUX_REV=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*.[0B]*//'`
+ case $UNAME_MACHINE in
9000/31?) HP_ARCH=m68000 ;;
9000/[34]??) HP_ARCH=m68k ;;
9000/[678][0-9][0-9])
- if [ -x /usr/bin/getconf ]; then
+ if test -x /usr/bin/getconf; then
sc_cpu_version=`/usr/bin/getconf SC_CPU_VERSION 2>/dev/null`
sc_kernel_bits=`/usr/bin/getconf SC_KERNEL_BITS 2>/dev/null`
- case "$sc_cpu_version" in
+ case $sc_cpu_version in
523) HP_ARCH=hppa1.0 ;; # CPU_PA_RISC1_0
528) HP_ARCH=hppa1.1 ;; # CPU_PA_RISC1_1
532) # CPU_PA_RISC2_0
- case "$sc_kernel_bits" in
+ case $sc_kernel_bits in
32) HP_ARCH=hppa2.0n ;;
64) HP_ARCH=hppa2.0w ;;
'') HP_ARCH=hppa2.0 ;; # HP-UX 10.20
esac ;;
esac
fi
- if [ "$HP_ARCH" = "" ]; then
+ if test "$HP_ARCH" = ""; then
set_cc_for_build
sed 's/^ //' << EOF > "$dummy.c"
@@ -708,7 +743,7 @@ EOF
test -z "$HP_ARCH" && HP_ARCH=hppa
fi ;;
esac
- if [ "$HP_ARCH" = hppa2.0w ]
+ if test "$HP_ARCH" = hppa2.0w
then
set_cc_for_build
@@ -729,12 +764,12 @@ EOF
HP_ARCH=hppa64
fi
fi
- echo "$HP_ARCH"-hp-hpux"$HPUX_REV"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$HP_ARCH-hp-hpux$HPUX_REV
+ ;;
ia64:HP-UX:*:*)
- HPUX_REV=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[^.]*.[0B]*//'`
- echo ia64-hp-hpux"$HPUX_REV"
- exit ;;
+ HPUX_REV=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*.[0B]*//'`
+ GUESS=ia64-hp-hpux$HPUX_REV
+ ;;
3050*:HI-UX:*:*)
set_cc_for_build
sed 's/^ //' << EOF > "$dummy.c"
@@ -764,36 +799,36 @@ EOF
EOF
$CC_FOR_BUILD -o "$dummy" "$dummy.c" && SYSTEM_NAME=`"$dummy"` &&
{ echo "$SYSTEM_NAME"; exit; }
- echo unknown-hitachi-hiuxwe2
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=unknown-hitachi-hiuxwe2
+ ;;
9000/7??:4.3bsd:*:* | 9000/8?[79]:4.3bsd:*:*)
- echo hppa1.1-hp-bsd
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.1-hp-bsd
+ ;;
9000/8??:4.3bsd:*:*)
- echo hppa1.0-hp-bsd
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.0-hp-bsd
+ ;;
*9??*:MPE/iX:*:* | *3000*:MPE/iX:*:*)
- echo hppa1.0-hp-mpeix
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.0-hp-mpeix
+ ;;
hp7??:OSF1:*:* | hp8?[79]:OSF1:*:*)
- echo hppa1.1-hp-osf
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.1-hp-osf
+ ;;
hp8??:OSF1:*:*)
- echo hppa1.0-hp-osf
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.0-hp-osf
+ ;;
i*86:OSF1:*:*)
- if [ -x /usr/sbin/sysversion ] ; then
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-osf1mk
+ if test -x /usr/sbin/sysversion ; then
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-osf1mk
else
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-osf1
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-osf1
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
parisc*:Lites*:*:*)
- echo hppa1.1-hp-lites
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.1-hp-lites
+ ;;
C1*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C1*:*)
- echo c1-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=c1-convex-bsd
+ ;;
C2*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C2*:*)
if getsysinfo -f scalar_acc
then echo c32-convex-bsd
@@ -801,17 +836,18 @@ EOF
fi
exit ;;
C34*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C34*:*)
- echo c34-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=c34-convex-bsd
+ ;;
C38*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C38*:*)
- echo c38-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=c38-convex-bsd
+ ;;
C4*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C4*:*)
- echo c4-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=c4-convex-bsd
+ ;;
CRAY*Y-MP:*:*:*)
- echo ymp-cray-unicos"$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'
- exit ;;
+ CRAY_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'`
+ GUESS=ymp-cray-unicos$CRAY_REL
+ ;;
CRAY*[A-Z]90:*:*:*)
echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-cray-unicos"$UNAME_RELEASE" \
| sed -e 's/CRAY.*\([A-Z]90\)/\1/' \
@@ -819,112 +855,127 @@ EOF
-e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'
exit ;;
CRAY*TS:*:*:*)
- echo t90-cray-unicos"$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'
- exit ;;
+ CRAY_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'`
+ GUESS=t90-cray-unicos$CRAY_REL
+ ;;
CRAY*T3E:*:*:*)
- echo alphaev5-cray-unicosmk"$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'
- exit ;;
+ CRAY_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'`
+ GUESS=alphaev5-cray-unicosmk$CRAY_REL
+ ;;
CRAY*SV1:*:*:*)
- echo sv1-cray-unicos"$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'
- exit ;;
+ CRAY_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'`
+ GUESS=sv1-cray-unicos$CRAY_REL
+ ;;
*:UNICOS/mp:*:*)
- echo craynv-cray-unicosmp"$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'
- exit ;;
+ CRAY_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'`
+ GUESS=craynv-cray-unicosmp$CRAY_REL
+ ;;
F30[01]:UNIX_System_V:*:* | F700:UNIX_System_V:*:*)
FUJITSU_PROC=`uname -m | tr ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz`
FUJITSU_SYS=`uname -p | tr ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz | sed -e 's/\///'`
FUJITSU_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/ /_/'`
- echo "${FUJITSU_PROC}-fujitsu-${FUJITSU_SYS}${FUJITSU_REL}"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=${FUJITSU_PROC}-fujitsu-${FUJITSU_SYS}${FUJITSU_REL}
+ ;;
5000:UNIX_System_V:4.*:*)
FUJITSU_SYS=`uname -p | tr ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz | sed -e 's/\///'`
FUJITSU_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | tr ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz | sed -e 's/ /_/'`
- echo "sparc-fujitsu-${FUJITSU_SYS}${FUJITSU_REL}"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sparc-fujitsu-${FUJITSU_SYS}${FUJITSU_REL}
+ ;;
i*86:BSD/386:*:* | i*86:BSD/OS:*:* | *:Ascend\ Embedded/OS:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-bsdi"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-bsdi$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
sparc*:BSD/OS:*:*)
- echo sparc-unknown-bsdi"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sparc-unknown-bsdi$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:BSD/OS:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-bsdi"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-bsdi$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
arm:FreeBSD:*:*)
UNAME_PROCESSOR=`uname -p`
set_cc_for_build
if echo __ARM_PCS_VFP | $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null \
| grep -q __ARM_PCS_VFP
then
- echo "${UNAME_PROCESSOR}"-unknown-freebsd"`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`"-gnueabi
+ FREEBSD_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_PROCESSOR-unknown-freebsd$FREEBSD_REL-gnueabi
else
- echo "${UNAME_PROCESSOR}"-unknown-freebsd"`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`"-gnueabihf
+ FREEBSD_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_PROCESSOR-unknown-freebsd$FREEBSD_REL-gnueabihf
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
*:FreeBSD:*:*)
UNAME_PROCESSOR=`/usr/bin/uname -p`
- case "$UNAME_PROCESSOR" in
+ case $UNAME_PROCESSOR in
amd64)
UNAME_PROCESSOR=x86_64 ;;
i386)
UNAME_PROCESSOR=i586 ;;
esac
- echo "$UNAME_PROCESSOR"-unknown-freebsd"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`"
- exit ;;
+ FREEBSD_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_PROCESSOR-unknown-freebsd$FREEBSD_REL
+ ;;
i*:CYGWIN*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-cygwin
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-cygwin
+ ;;
*:MINGW64*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-mingw64
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-mingw64
+ ;;
*:MINGW*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-mingw32
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-mingw32
+ ;;
*:MSYS*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-msys
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-msys
+ ;;
i*:PW*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-pw32
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-pw32
+ ;;
+ *:SerenityOS:*:*)
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-serenity
+ ;;
*:Interix*:*)
- case "$UNAME_MACHINE" in
+ case $UNAME_MACHINE in
x86)
- echo i586-pc-interix"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i586-pc-interix$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
authenticamd | genuineintel | EM64T)
- echo x86_64-unknown-interix"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=x86_64-unknown-interix$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
IA64)
- echo ia64-unknown-interix"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=ia64-unknown-interix$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
esac ;;
i*:UWIN*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-uwin
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-uwin
+ ;;
amd64:CYGWIN*:*:* | x86_64:CYGWIN*:*:*)
- echo x86_64-pc-cygwin
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=x86_64-pc-cygwin
+ ;;
prep*:SunOS:5.*:*)
- echo powerpcle-unknown-solaris2"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`"
- exit ;;
+ SUN_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
+ GUESS=powerpcle-unknown-solaris2$SUN_REL
+ ;;
*:GNU:*:*)
# the GNU system
- echo "`echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"|sed -e 's,[-/].*$,,'`-unknown-$LIBC`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's,/.*$,,'`"
- exit ;;
+ GNU_ARCH=`echo "$UNAME_MACHINE" | sed -e 's,[-/].*$,,'`
+ GNU_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's,/.*$,,'`
+ GUESS=$GNU_ARCH-unknown-$LIBC$GNU_REL
+ ;;
*:GNU/*:*:*)
# other systems with GNU libc and userland
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-`echo "$UNAME_SYSTEM" | sed 's,^[^/]*/,,' | tr "[:upper:]" "[:lower:]"``echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`-$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GNU_SYS=`echo "$UNAME_SYSTEM" | sed 's,^[^/]*/,,' | tr "[:upper:]" "[:lower:]"`
+ GNU_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-$GNU_SYS$GNU_REL-$LIBC
+ ;;
*:Minix:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-minix
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-minix
+ ;;
aarch64:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
aarch64_be:Linux:*:*)
UNAME_MACHINE=aarch64_be
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
alpha:Linux:*:*)
case `sed -n '/^cpu model/s/^.*: \(.*\)/\1/p' /proc/cpuinfo 2>/dev/null` in
EV5) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev5 ;;
@@ -937,60 +988,63 @@ EOF
esac
objdump --private-headers /bin/sh | grep -q ld.so.1
if test "$?" = 0 ; then LIBC=gnulibc1 ; fi
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
- arc:Linux:*:* | arceb:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
+ arc:Linux:*:* | arceb:Linux:*:* | arc32:Linux:*:* | arc64:Linux:*:*)
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
arm*:Linux:*:*)
set_cc_for_build
if echo __ARM_EABI__ | $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null \
| grep -q __ARM_EABI__
then
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
else
if echo __ARM_PCS_VFP | $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null \
| grep -q __ARM_PCS_VFP
then
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"eabi
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-${LIBC}eabi
else
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"eabihf
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-${LIBC}eabihf
fi
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
avr32*:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
cris:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-axis-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-axis-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
crisv32:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-axis-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-axis-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
e2k:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
frv:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
hexagon:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
i*86:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
ia64:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
k1om:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
+ loongarch32:Linux:*:* | loongarch64:Linux:*:* | loongarchx32:Linux:*:*)
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
m32r*:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
m68*:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
mips:Linux:*:* | mips64:Linux:*:*)
set_cc_for_build
IS_GLIBC=0
@@ -1035,113 +1089,124 @@ EOF
#endif
#endif
EOF
- eval "`$CC_FOR_BUILD -E "$dummy.c" 2>/dev/null | grep '^CPU\|^MIPS_ENDIAN\|^LIBCABI'`"
+ cc_set_vars=`$CC_FOR_BUILD -E "$dummy.c" 2>/dev/null | grep '^CPU\|^MIPS_ENDIAN\|^LIBCABI'`
+ eval "$cc_set_vars"
test "x$CPU" != x && { echo "$CPU${MIPS_ENDIAN}-unknown-linux-$LIBCABI"; exit; }
;;
mips64el:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
openrisc*:Linux:*:*)
- echo or1k-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=or1k-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
or32:Linux:*:* | or1k*:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
padre:Linux:*:*)
- echo sparc-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sparc-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
parisc64:Linux:*:* | hppa64:Linux:*:*)
- echo hppa64-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa64-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
parisc:Linux:*:* | hppa:Linux:*:*)
# Look for CPU level
case `grep '^cpu[^a-z]*:' /proc/cpuinfo 2>/dev/null | cut -d' ' -f2` in
- PA7*) echo hppa1.1-unknown-linux-"$LIBC" ;;
- PA8*) echo hppa2.0-unknown-linux-"$LIBC" ;;
- *) echo hppa-unknown-linux-"$LIBC" ;;
+ PA7*) GUESS=hppa1.1-unknown-linux-$LIBC ;;
+ PA8*) GUESS=hppa2.0-unknown-linux-$LIBC ;;
+ *) GUESS=hppa-unknown-linux-$LIBC ;;
esac
- exit ;;
+ ;;
ppc64:Linux:*:*)
- echo powerpc64-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc64-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
ppc:Linux:*:*)
- echo powerpc-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
ppc64le:Linux:*:*)
- echo powerpc64le-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc64le-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
ppcle:Linux:*:*)
- echo powerpcle-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
- riscv32:Linux:*:* | riscv64:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpcle-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
+ riscv32:Linux:*:* | riscv32be:Linux:*:* | riscv64:Linux:*:* | riscv64be:Linux:*:*)
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
s390:Linux:*:* | s390x:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-ibm-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-ibm-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
sh64*:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
sh*:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
sparc:Linux:*:* | sparc64:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
tile*:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
vax:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-dec-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-dec-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
x86_64:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ set_cc_for_build
+ LIBCABI=$LIBC
+ if test "$CC_FOR_BUILD" != no_compiler_found; then
+ if (echo '#ifdef __ILP32__'; echo IS_X32; echo '#endif') | \
+ (CCOPTS="" $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null) | \
+ grep IS_X32 >/dev/null
+ then
+ LIBCABI=${LIBC}x32
+ fi
+ fi
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-linux-$LIBCABI
+ ;;
xtensa*:Linux:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-linux-"$LIBC"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-linux-$LIBC
+ ;;
i*86:DYNIX/ptx:4*:*)
# ptx 4.0 does uname -s correctly, with DYNIX/ptx in there.
# earlier versions are messed up and put the nodename in both
# sysname and nodename.
- echo i386-sequent-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i386-sequent-sysv4
+ ;;
i*86:UNIX_SV:4.2MP:2.*)
# Unixware is an offshoot of SVR4, but it has its own version
# number series starting with 2...
# I am not positive that other SVR4 systems won't match this,
# I just have to hope. -- rms.
# Use sysv4.2uw... so that sysv4* matches it.
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-sysv4.2uw"$UNAME_VERSION"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-sysv4.2uw$UNAME_VERSION
+ ;;
i*86:OS/2:*:*)
# If we were able to find `uname', then EMX Unix compatibility
# is probably installed.
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-os2-emx
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-os2-emx
+ ;;
i*86:XTS-300:*:STOP)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-stop
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-stop
+ ;;
i*86:atheos:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-atheos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-atheos
+ ;;
i*86:syllable:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-syllable
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-syllable
+ ;;
i*86:LynxOS:2.*:* | i*86:LynxOS:3.[01]*:* | i*86:LynxOS:4.[02]*:*)
- echo i386-unknown-lynxos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i386-unknown-lynxos$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
i*86:*DOS:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-msdosdjgpp
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-msdosdjgpp
+ ;;
i*86:*:4.*:*)
UNAME_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed 's/\/MP$//'`
if grep Novell /usr/include/link.h >/dev/null 2>/dev/null; then
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-univel-sysv"$UNAME_REL"
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-univel-sysv$UNAME_REL
else
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-sysv"$UNAME_REL"
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-sysv$UNAME_REL
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
i*86:*:5:[678]*)
# UnixWare 7.x, OpenUNIX and OpenServer 6.
case `/bin/uname -X | grep "^Machine"` in
@@ -1149,12 +1214,12 @@ EOF
*Pentium) UNAME_MACHINE=i586 ;;
*Pent*|*Celeron) UNAME_MACHINE=i686 ;;
esac
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-sysv${UNAME_RELEASE}${UNAME_SYSTEM}${UNAME_VERSION}"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-sysv${UNAME_RELEASE}${UNAME_SYSTEM}${UNAME_VERSION}
+ ;;
i*86:*:3.2:*)
if test -f /usr/options/cb.name; then
UNAME_REL=`sed -n 's/.*Version //p' </usr/options/cb.name`
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-isc"$UNAME_REL"
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-isc$UNAME_REL
elif /bin/uname -X 2>/dev/null >/dev/null ; then
UNAME_REL=`(/bin/uname -X|grep Release|sed -e 's/.*= //')`
(/bin/uname -X|grep i80486 >/dev/null) && UNAME_MACHINE=i486
@@ -1164,11 +1229,11 @@ EOF
&& UNAME_MACHINE=i686
(/bin/uname -X|grep '^Machine.*Pentium Pro' >/dev/null) \
&& UNAME_MACHINE=i686
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-sco"$UNAME_REL"
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-sco$UNAME_REL
else
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-sysv32
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-sysv32
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
pc:*:*:*)
# Left here for compatibility:
# uname -m prints for DJGPP always 'pc', but it prints nothing about
@@ -1176,31 +1241,31 @@ EOF
# Note: whatever this is, it MUST be the same as what config.sub
# prints for the "djgpp" host, or else GDB configure will decide that
# this is a cross-build.
- echo i586-pc-msdosdjgpp
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i586-pc-msdosdjgpp
+ ;;
Intel:Mach:3*:*)
- echo i386-pc-mach3
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i386-pc-mach3
+ ;;
paragon:*:*:*)
- echo i860-intel-osf1
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i860-intel-osf1
+ ;;
i860:*:4.*:*) # i860-SVR4
if grep Stardent /usr/include/sys/uadmin.h >/dev/null 2>&1 ; then
- echo i860-stardent-sysv"$UNAME_RELEASE" # Stardent Vistra i860-SVR4
+ GUESS=i860-stardent-sysv$UNAME_RELEASE # Stardent Vistra i860-SVR4
else # Add other i860-SVR4 vendors below as they are discovered.
- echo i860-unknown-sysv"$UNAME_RELEASE" # Unknown i860-SVR4
+ GUESS=i860-unknown-sysv$UNAME_RELEASE # Unknown i860-SVR4
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
mini*:CTIX:SYS*5:*)
# "miniframe"
- echo m68010-convergent-sysv
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68010-convergent-sysv
+ ;;
mc68k:UNIX:SYSTEM5:3.51m)
- echo m68k-convergent-sysv
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-convergent-sysv
+ ;;
M680?0:D-NIX:5.3:*)
- echo m68k-diab-dnix
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-diab-dnix
+ ;;
M68*:*:R3V[5678]*:*)
test -r /sysV68 && { echo 'm68k-motorola-sysv'; exit; } ;;
3[345]??:*:4.0:3.0 | 3[34]??A:*:4.0:3.0 | 3[34]??,*:*:4.0:3.0 | 3[34]??/*:*:4.0:3.0 | 4400:*:4.0:3.0 | 4850:*:4.0:3.0 | SKA40:*:4.0:3.0 | SDS2:*:4.0:3.0 | SHG2:*:4.0:3.0 | S7501*:*:4.0:3.0)
@@ -1225,113 +1290,116 @@ EOF
/bin/uname -p 2>/dev/null | /bin/grep pteron >/dev/null \
&& { echo i586-ncr-sysv4.3"$OS_REL"; exit; } ;;
m68*:LynxOS:2.*:* | m68*:LynxOS:3.0*:*)
- echo m68k-unknown-lynxos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-unknown-lynxos$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
mc68030:UNIX_System_V:4.*:*)
- echo m68k-atari-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-atari-sysv4
+ ;;
TSUNAMI:LynxOS:2.*:*)
- echo sparc-unknown-lynxos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sparc-unknown-lynxos$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
rs6000:LynxOS:2.*:*)
- echo rs6000-unknown-lynxos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=rs6000-unknown-lynxos$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
PowerPC:LynxOS:2.*:* | PowerPC:LynxOS:3.[01]*:* | PowerPC:LynxOS:4.[02]*:*)
- echo powerpc-unknown-lynxos"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-unknown-lynxos$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
SM[BE]S:UNIX_SV:*:*)
- echo mips-dde-sysv"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-dde-sysv$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
RM*:ReliantUNIX-*:*:*)
- echo mips-sni-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-sni-sysv4
+ ;;
RM*:SINIX-*:*:*)
- echo mips-sni-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-sni-sysv4
+ ;;
*:SINIX-*:*:*)
if uname -p 2>/dev/null >/dev/null ; then
UNAME_MACHINE=`(uname -p) 2>/dev/null`
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-sni-sysv4
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-sni-sysv4
else
- echo ns32k-sni-sysv
+ GUESS=ns32k-sni-sysv
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
PENTIUM:*:4.0*:*) # Unisys `ClearPath HMP IX 4000' SVR4/MP effort
# says <Richard.M.Bartel@ccMail.Census.GOV>
- echo i586-unisys-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i586-unisys-sysv4
+ ;;
*:UNIX_System_V:4*:FTX*)
# From Gerald Hewes <hewes@openmarket.com>.
# How about differentiating between stratus architectures? -djm
- echo hppa1.1-stratus-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.1-stratus-sysv4
+ ;;
*:*:*:FTX*)
# From seanf@swdc.stratus.com.
- echo i860-stratus-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i860-stratus-sysv4
+ ;;
i*86:VOS:*:*)
# From Paul.Green@stratus.com.
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-stratus-vos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-stratus-vos
+ ;;
*:VOS:*:*)
# From Paul.Green@stratus.com.
- echo hppa1.1-stratus-vos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=hppa1.1-stratus-vos
+ ;;
mc68*:A/UX:*:*)
- echo m68k-apple-aux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=m68k-apple-aux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
news*:NEWS-OS:6*:*)
- echo mips-sony-newsos6
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-sony-newsos6
+ ;;
R[34]000:*System_V*:*:* | R4000:UNIX_SYSV:*:* | R*000:UNIX_SV:*:*)
- if [ -d /usr/nec ]; then
- echo mips-nec-sysv"$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ if test -d /usr/nec; then
+ GUESS=mips-nec-sysv$UNAME_RELEASE
else
- echo mips-unknown-sysv"$UNAME_RELEASE"
+ GUESS=mips-unknown-sysv$UNAME_RELEASE
fi
- exit ;;
+ ;;
BeBox:BeOS:*:*) # BeOS running on hardware made by Be, PPC only.
- echo powerpc-be-beos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-be-beos
+ ;;
BeMac:BeOS:*:*) # BeOS running on Mac or Mac clone, PPC only.
- echo powerpc-apple-beos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-apple-beos
+ ;;
BePC:BeOS:*:*) # BeOS running on Intel PC compatible.
- echo i586-pc-beos
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i586-pc-beos
+ ;;
BePC:Haiku:*:*) # Haiku running on Intel PC compatible.
- echo i586-pc-haiku
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i586-pc-haiku
+ ;;
x86_64:Haiku:*:*)
- echo x86_64-unknown-haiku
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=x86_64-unknown-haiku
+ ;;
SX-4:SUPER-UX:*:*)
- echo sx4-nec-superux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sx4-nec-superux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
SX-5:SUPER-UX:*:*)
- echo sx5-nec-superux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sx5-nec-superux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
SX-6:SUPER-UX:*:*)
- echo sx6-nec-superux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sx6-nec-superux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
SX-7:SUPER-UX:*:*)
- echo sx7-nec-superux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sx7-nec-superux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
SX-8:SUPER-UX:*:*)
- echo sx8-nec-superux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sx8-nec-superux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
SX-8R:SUPER-UX:*:*)
- echo sx8r-nec-superux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sx8r-nec-superux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
SX-ACE:SUPER-UX:*:*)
- echo sxace-nec-superux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=sxace-nec-superux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
Power*:Rhapsody:*:*)
- echo powerpc-apple-rhapsody"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=powerpc-apple-rhapsody$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:Rhapsody:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-apple-rhapsody"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-apple-rhapsody$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
+ arm64:Darwin:*:*)
+ GUESS=aarch64-apple-darwin$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:Darwin:*:*)
UNAME_PROCESSOR=`uname -p`
case $UNAME_PROCESSOR in
@@ -1346,7 +1414,7 @@ EOF
else
set_cc_for_build
fi
- if [ "$CC_FOR_BUILD" != no_compiler_found ]; then
+ if test "$CC_FOR_BUILD" != no_compiler_found; then
if (echo '#ifdef __LP64__'; echo IS_64BIT_ARCH; echo '#endif') | \
(CCOPTS="" $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null) | \
grep IS_64BIT_ARCH >/dev/null
@@ -1367,109 +1435,119 @@ EOF
# uname -m returns i386 or x86_64
UNAME_PROCESSOR=$UNAME_MACHINE
fi
- echo "$UNAME_PROCESSOR"-apple-darwin"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_PROCESSOR-apple-darwin$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:procnto*:*:* | *:QNX:[0123456789]*:*)
UNAME_PROCESSOR=`uname -p`
if test "$UNAME_PROCESSOR" = x86; then
UNAME_PROCESSOR=i386
UNAME_MACHINE=pc
fi
- echo "$UNAME_PROCESSOR"-"$UNAME_MACHINE"-nto-qnx"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_PROCESSOR-$UNAME_MACHINE-nto-qnx$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:QNX:*:4*)
- echo i386-pc-qnx
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i386-pc-qnx
+ ;;
NEO-*:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
- echo neo-tandem-nsk"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=neo-tandem-nsk$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
NSE-*:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
- echo nse-tandem-nsk"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=nse-tandem-nsk$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
NSR-*:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
- echo nsr-tandem-nsk"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=nsr-tandem-nsk$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
NSV-*:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
- echo nsv-tandem-nsk"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=nsv-tandem-nsk$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
NSX-*:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
- echo nsx-tandem-nsk"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=nsx-tandem-nsk$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:NonStop-UX:*:*)
- echo mips-compaq-nonstopux
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-compaq-nonstopux
+ ;;
BS2000:POSIX*:*:*)
- echo bs2000-siemens-sysv
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=bs2000-siemens-sysv
+ ;;
DS/*:UNIX_System_V:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-"$UNAME_SYSTEM"-"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-$UNAME_SYSTEM-$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:Plan9:*:*)
# "uname -m" is not consistent, so use $cputype instead. 386
# is converted to i386 for consistency with other x86
# operating systems.
- # shellcheck disable=SC2154
- if test "$cputype" = 386; then
+ if test "${cputype-}" = 386; then
UNAME_MACHINE=i386
- else
- UNAME_MACHINE="$cputype"
+ elif test "x${cputype-}" != x; then
+ UNAME_MACHINE=$cputype
fi
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-plan9
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-plan9
+ ;;
*:TOPS-10:*:*)
- echo pdp10-unknown-tops10
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=pdp10-unknown-tops10
+ ;;
*:TENEX:*:*)
- echo pdp10-unknown-tenex
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=pdp10-unknown-tenex
+ ;;
KS10:TOPS-20:*:* | KL10:TOPS-20:*:* | TYPE4:TOPS-20:*:*)
- echo pdp10-dec-tops20
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=pdp10-dec-tops20
+ ;;
XKL-1:TOPS-20:*:* | TYPE5:TOPS-20:*:*)
- echo pdp10-xkl-tops20
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=pdp10-xkl-tops20
+ ;;
*:TOPS-20:*:*)
- echo pdp10-unknown-tops20
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=pdp10-unknown-tops20
+ ;;
*:ITS:*:*)
- echo pdp10-unknown-its
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=pdp10-unknown-its
+ ;;
SEI:*:*:SEIUX)
- echo mips-sei-seiux"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=mips-sei-seiux$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
*:DragonFly:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-dragonfly"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE"|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`"
- exit ;;
+ DRAGONFLY_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-dragonfly$DRAGONFLY_REL
+ ;;
*:*VMS:*:*)
UNAME_MACHINE=`(uname -p) 2>/dev/null`
- case "$UNAME_MACHINE" in
- A*) echo alpha-dec-vms ; exit ;;
- I*) echo ia64-dec-vms ; exit ;;
- V*) echo vax-dec-vms ; exit ;;
+ case $UNAME_MACHINE in
+ A*) GUESS=alpha-dec-vms ;;
+ I*) GUESS=ia64-dec-vms ;;
+ V*) GUESS=vax-dec-vms ;;
esac ;;
*:XENIX:*:SysV)
- echo i386-pc-xenix
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=i386-pc-xenix
+ ;;
i*86:skyos:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-skyos"`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/ .*$//'`"
- exit ;;
+ SKYOS_REL=`echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/ .*$//'`
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-skyos$SKYOS_REL
+ ;;
i*86:rdos:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-rdos
- exit ;;
- i*86:AROS:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-pc-aros
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-rdos
+ ;;
+ i*86:Fiwix:*:*)
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-pc-fiwix
+ ;;
+ *:AROS:*:*)
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-aros
+ ;;
x86_64:VMkernel:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-esx
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-esx
+ ;;
amd64:Isilon\ OneFS:*:*)
- echo x86_64-unknown-onefs
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=x86_64-unknown-onefs
+ ;;
*:Unleashed:*:*)
- echo "$UNAME_MACHINE"-unknown-unleashed"$UNAME_RELEASE"
- exit ;;
+ GUESS=$UNAME_MACHINE-unknown-unleashed$UNAME_RELEASE
+ ;;
esac
+# Do we have a guess based on uname results?
+if test "x$GUESS" != x; then
+ echo "$GUESS"
+ exit
+fi
+
# No uname command or uname output not recognized.
set_cc_for_build
cat > "$dummy.c" <<EOF
@@ -1601,7 +1679,7 @@ main ()
}
EOF
-$CC_FOR_BUILD -o "$dummy" "$dummy.c" 2>/dev/null && SYSTEM_NAME=`$dummy` &&
+$CC_FOR_BUILD -o "$dummy" "$dummy.c" 2>/dev/null && SYSTEM_NAME=`"$dummy"` &&
{ echo "$SYSTEM_NAME"; exit; }
# Apollos put the system type in the environment.
@@ -1609,7 +1687,7 @@ test -d /usr/apollo && { echo "$ISP-apollo-$SYSTYPE"; exit; }
echo "$0: unable to guess system type" >&2
-case "$UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM" in
+case $UNAME_MACHINE:$UNAME_SYSTEM in
mips:Linux | mips64:Linux)
# If we got here on MIPS GNU/Linux, output extra information.
cat >&2 <<EOF
@@ -1626,14 +1704,16 @@ This script (version $timestamp), has failed to recognize the
operating system you are using. If your script is old, overwrite *all*
copies of config.guess and config.sub with the latest versions from:
- https://git.savannah.gnu.org/gitweb/?p=config.git;a=blob_plain;f=config.guess
+ https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/config.git/plain/config.guess
and
- https://git.savannah.gnu.org/gitweb/?p=config.git;a=blob_plain;f=config.sub
+ https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/config.git/plain/config.sub
EOF
-year=`echo $timestamp | sed 's,-.*,,'`
+our_year=`echo $timestamp | sed 's,-.*,,'`
+thisyear=`date +%Y`
# shellcheck disable=SC2003
-if test "`expr "\`date +%Y\`" - "$year"`" -lt 3 ; then
+script_age=`expr "$thisyear" - "$our_year"`
+if test "$script_age" -lt 3 ; then
cat >&2 <<EOF
If $0 has already been updated, send the following data and any
diff --git a/build-aux/config.rpath b/build-aux/config.rpath
index 24be79cf..1e1ab679 100755
--- a/build-aux/config.rpath
+++ b/build-aux/config.rpath
@@ -2,7 +2,7 @@
# Output a system dependent set of variables, describing how to set the
# run time search path of shared libraries in an executable.
#
-# Copyright 1996-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright 1996-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# Taken from GNU libtool, 2001
# Originally by Gordon Matzigkeit <gord@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996
#
@@ -371,7 +371,7 @@ else
hardcode_direct=yes
hardcode_minus_L=yes
;;
- freebsd* | dragonfly*)
+ freebsd* | dragonfly* | midnightbsd*)
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
hardcode_direct=yes
;;
@@ -547,7 +547,7 @@ case "$host_os" in
freebsd[23].*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext$versuffix'
;;
- freebsd* | dragonfly*)
+ freebsd* | dragonfly* | midnightbsd*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
gnu*)
diff --git a/build-aux/config.sub b/build-aux/config.sub
index 973a2980..9b62e37c 100755
--- a/build-aux/config.sub
+++ b/build-aux/config.sub
@@ -1,12 +1,14 @@
#! /bin/sh
# Configuration validation subroutine script.
-# Copyright 1992-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright 1992-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-timestamp='2020-05-04'
+# shellcheck disable=SC2006,SC2268 # see below for rationale
+
+timestamp='2021-12-25'
# This file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
# under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
+# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
# (at your option) any later version.
#
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
@@ -33,7 +35,7 @@ timestamp='2020-05-04'
# Otherwise, we print the canonical config type on stdout and succeed.
# You can get the latest version of this script from:
-# https://git.savannah.gnu.org/gitweb/?p=config.git;a=blob_plain;f=config.sub
+# https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/config.git/plain/config.sub
# This file is supposed to be the same for all GNU packages
# and recognize all the CPU types, system types and aliases
@@ -50,6 +52,13 @@ timestamp='2020-05-04'
# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM
# It is wrong to echo any other type of specification.
+# The "shellcheck disable" line above the timestamp inhibits complaints
+# about features and limitations of the classic Bourne shell that were
+# superseded or lifted in POSIX. However, this script identifies a wide
+# variety of pre-POSIX systems that do not have POSIX shells at all, and
+# even some reasonably current systems (Solaris 10 as case-in-point) still
+# have a pre-POSIX /bin/sh.
+
me=`echo "$0" | sed -e 's,.*/,,'`
usage="\
@@ -67,7 +76,7 @@ Report bugs and patches to <config-patches@gnu.org>."
version="\
GNU config.sub ($timestamp)
-Copyright 1992-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+Copyright 1992-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This is free software; see the source for copying conditions. There is NO
warranty; not even for MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE."
@@ -112,9 +121,11 @@ esac
# Split fields of configuration type
# shellcheck disable=SC2162
+saved_IFS=$IFS
IFS="-" read field1 field2 field3 field4 <<EOF
$1
EOF
+IFS=$saved_IFS
# Separate into logical components for further validation
case $1 in
@@ -124,28 +135,27 @@ case $1 in
;;
*-*-*-*)
basic_machine=$field1-$field2
- os=$field3-$field4
+ basic_os=$field3-$field4
;;
*-*-*)
# Ambiguous whether COMPANY is present, or skipped and KERNEL-OS is two
# parts
maybe_os=$field2-$field3
case $maybe_os in
- nto-qnx* | linux-gnu* | linux-android* | linux-dietlibc \
- | linux-newlib* | linux-musl* | linux-uclibc* | uclinux-uclibc* \
+ nto-qnx* | linux-* | uclinux-uclibc* \
| uclinux-gnu* | kfreebsd*-gnu* | knetbsd*-gnu* | netbsd*-gnu* \
| netbsd*-eabi* | kopensolaris*-gnu* | cloudabi*-eabi* \
| storm-chaos* | os2-emx* | rtmk-nova*)
basic_machine=$field1
- os=$maybe_os
+ basic_os=$maybe_os
;;
android-linux)
basic_machine=$field1-unknown
- os=linux-android
+ basic_os=linux-android
;;
*)
basic_machine=$field1-$field2
- os=$field3
+ basic_os=$field3
;;
esac
;;
@@ -154,7 +164,7 @@ case $1 in
case $field1-$field2 in
decstation-3100)
basic_machine=mips-dec
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
*-*)
# Second component is usually, but not always the OS
@@ -162,7 +172,11 @@ case $1 in
# Prevent following clause from handling this valid os
sun*os*)
basic_machine=$field1
- os=$field2
+ basic_os=$field2
+ ;;
+ zephyr*)
+ basic_machine=$field1-unknown
+ basic_os=$field2
;;
# Manufacturers
dec* | mips* | sequent* | encore* | pc533* | sgi* | sony* \
@@ -175,11 +189,11 @@ case $1 in
| microblaze* | sim | cisco \
| oki | wec | wrs | winbond)
basic_machine=$field1-$field2
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
*)
basic_machine=$field1
- os=$field2
+ basic_os=$field2
;;
esac
;;
@@ -191,447 +205,451 @@ case $1 in
case $field1 in
386bsd)
basic_machine=i386-pc
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
a29khif)
basic_machine=a29k-amd
- os=udi
+ basic_os=udi
;;
adobe68k)
basic_machine=m68010-adobe
- os=scout
+ basic_os=scout
;;
alliant)
basic_machine=fx80-alliant
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
altos | altos3068)
basic_machine=m68k-altos
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
am29k)
basic_machine=a29k-none
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
amdahl)
basic_machine=580-amdahl
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
amiga)
basic_machine=m68k-unknown
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
amigaos | amigados)
basic_machine=m68k-unknown
- os=amigaos
+ basic_os=amigaos
;;
amigaunix | amix)
basic_machine=m68k-unknown
- os=sysv4
+ basic_os=sysv4
;;
apollo68)
basic_machine=m68k-apollo
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
apollo68bsd)
basic_machine=m68k-apollo
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
aros)
basic_machine=i386-pc
- os=aros
+ basic_os=aros
;;
aux)
basic_machine=m68k-apple
- os=aux
+ basic_os=aux
;;
balance)
basic_machine=ns32k-sequent
- os=dynix
+ basic_os=dynix
;;
blackfin)
basic_machine=bfin-unknown
- os=linux
+ basic_os=linux
;;
cegcc)
basic_machine=arm-unknown
- os=cegcc
+ basic_os=cegcc
;;
convex-c1)
basic_machine=c1-convex
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
convex-c2)
basic_machine=c2-convex
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
convex-c32)
basic_machine=c32-convex
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
convex-c34)
basic_machine=c34-convex
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
convex-c38)
basic_machine=c38-convex
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
cray)
basic_machine=j90-cray
- os=unicos
+ basic_os=unicos
;;
crds | unos)
basic_machine=m68k-crds
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
da30)
basic_machine=m68k-da30
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
decstation | pmax | pmin | dec3100 | decstatn)
basic_machine=mips-dec
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
delta88)
basic_machine=m88k-motorola
- os=sysv3
+ basic_os=sysv3
;;
dicos)
basic_machine=i686-pc
- os=dicos
+ basic_os=dicos
;;
djgpp)
basic_machine=i586-pc
- os=msdosdjgpp
+ basic_os=msdosdjgpp
;;
ebmon29k)
basic_machine=a29k-amd
- os=ebmon
+ basic_os=ebmon
;;
es1800 | OSE68k | ose68k | ose | OSE)
basic_machine=m68k-ericsson
- os=ose
+ basic_os=ose
;;
gmicro)
basic_machine=tron-gmicro
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
go32)
basic_machine=i386-pc
- os=go32
+ basic_os=go32
;;
h8300hms)
basic_machine=h8300-hitachi
- os=hms
+ basic_os=hms
;;
h8300xray)
basic_machine=h8300-hitachi
- os=xray
+ basic_os=xray
;;
h8500hms)
basic_machine=h8500-hitachi
- os=hms
+ basic_os=hms
;;
harris)
basic_machine=m88k-harris
- os=sysv3
+ basic_os=sysv3
;;
hp300 | hp300hpux)
basic_machine=m68k-hp
- os=hpux
+ basic_os=hpux
;;
hp300bsd)
basic_machine=m68k-hp
- os=bsd
+ basic_os=bsd
;;
hppaosf)
basic_machine=hppa1.1-hp
- os=osf
+ basic_os=osf
;;
hppro)
basic_machine=hppa1.1-hp
- os=proelf
+ basic_os=proelf
;;
i386mach)
basic_machine=i386-mach
- os=mach
+ basic_os=mach
;;
isi68 | isi)
basic_machine=m68k-isi
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
m68knommu)
basic_machine=m68k-unknown
- os=linux
+ basic_os=linux
;;
magnum | m3230)
basic_machine=mips-mips
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
merlin)
basic_machine=ns32k-utek
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
mingw64)
basic_machine=x86_64-pc
- os=mingw64
+ basic_os=mingw64
;;
mingw32)
basic_machine=i686-pc
- os=mingw32
+ basic_os=mingw32
;;
mingw32ce)
basic_machine=arm-unknown
- os=mingw32ce
+ basic_os=mingw32ce
;;
monitor)
basic_machine=m68k-rom68k
- os=coff
+ basic_os=coff
;;
morphos)
basic_machine=powerpc-unknown
- os=morphos
+ basic_os=morphos
;;
moxiebox)
basic_machine=moxie-unknown
- os=moxiebox
+ basic_os=moxiebox
;;
msdos)
basic_machine=i386-pc
- os=msdos
+ basic_os=msdos
;;
msys)
basic_machine=i686-pc
- os=msys
+ basic_os=msys
;;
mvs)
basic_machine=i370-ibm
- os=mvs
+ basic_os=mvs
;;
nacl)
basic_machine=le32-unknown
- os=nacl
+ basic_os=nacl
;;
ncr3000)
basic_machine=i486-ncr
- os=sysv4
+ basic_os=sysv4
;;
netbsd386)
basic_machine=i386-pc
- os=netbsd
+ basic_os=netbsd
;;
netwinder)
basic_machine=armv4l-rebel
- os=linux
+ basic_os=linux
;;
news | news700 | news800 | news900)
basic_machine=m68k-sony
- os=newsos
+ basic_os=newsos
;;
news1000)
basic_machine=m68030-sony
- os=newsos
+ basic_os=newsos
;;
necv70)
basic_machine=v70-nec
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
nh3000)
basic_machine=m68k-harris
- os=cxux
+ basic_os=cxux
;;
nh[45]000)
basic_machine=m88k-harris
- os=cxux
+ basic_os=cxux
;;
nindy960)
basic_machine=i960-intel
- os=nindy
+ basic_os=nindy
;;
mon960)
basic_machine=i960-intel
- os=mon960
+ basic_os=mon960
;;
nonstopux)
basic_machine=mips-compaq
- os=nonstopux
+ basic_os=nonstopux
;;
os400)
basic_machine=powerpc-ibm
- os=os400
+ basic_os=os400
;;
OSE68000 | ose68000)
basic_machine=m68000-ericsson
- os=ose
+ basic_os=ose
;;
os68k)
basic_machine=m68k-none
- os=os68k
+ basic_os=os68k
;;
paragon)
basic_machine=i860-intel
- os=osf
+ basic_os=osf
;;
parisc)
basic_machine=hppa-unknown
- os=linux
+ basic_os=linux
+ ;;
+ psp)
+ basic_machine=mipsallegrexel-sony
+ basic_os=psp
;;
pw32)
basic_machine=i586-unknown
- os=pw32
+ basic_os=pw32
;;
rdos | rdos64)
basic_machine=x86_64-pc
- os=rdos
+ basic_os=rdos
;;
rdos32)
basic_machine=i386-pc
- os=rdos
+ basic_os=rdos
;;
rom68k)
basic_machine=m68k-rom68k
- os=coff
+ basic_os=coff
;;
sa29200)
basic_machine=a29k-amd
- os=udi
+ basic_os=udi
;;
sei)
basic_machine=mips-sei
- os=seiux
+ basic_os=seiux
;;
sequent)
basic_machine=i386-sequent
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
sps7)
basic_machine=m68k-bull
- os=sysv2
+ basic_os=sysv2
;;
st2000)
basic_machine=m68k-tandem
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
stratus)
basic_machine=i860-stratus
- os=sysv4
+ basic_os=sysv4
;;
sun2)
basic_machine=m68000-sun
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
sun2os3)
basic_machine=m68000-sun
- os=sunos3
+ basic_os=sunos3
;;
sun2os4)
basic_machine=m68000-sun
- os=sunos4
+ basic_os=sunos4
;;
sun3)
basic_machine=m68k-sun
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
sun3os3)
basic_machine=m68k-sun
- os=sunos3
+ basic_os=sunos3
;;
sun3os4)
basic_machine=m68k-sun
- os=sunos4
+ basic_os=sunos4
;;
sun4)
basic_machine=sparc-sun
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
sun4os3)
basic_machine=sparc-sun
- os=sunos3
+ basic_os=sunos3
;;
sun4os4)
basic_machine=sparc-sun
- os=sunos4
+ basic_os=sunos4
;;
sun4sol2)
basic_machine=sparc-sun
- os=solaris2
+ basic_os=solaris2
;;
sun386 | sun386i | roadrunner)
basic_machine=i386-sun
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
sv1)
basic_machine=sv1-cray
- os=unicos
+ basic_os=unicos
;;
symmetry)
basic_machine=i386-sequent
- os=dynix
+ basic_os=dynix
;;
t3e)
basic_machine=alphaev5-cray
- os=unicos
+ basic_os=unicos
;;
t90)
basic_machine=t90-cray
- os=unicos
+ basic_os=unicos
;;
toad1)
basic_machine=pdp10-xkl
- os=tops20
+ basic_os=tops20
;;
tpf)
basic_machine=s390x-ibm
- os=tpf
+ basic_os=tpf
;;
udi29k)
basic_machine=a29k-amd
- os=udi
+ basic_os=udi
;;
ultra3)
basic_machine=a29k-nyu
- os=sym1
+ basic_os=sym1
;;
v810 | necv810)
basic_machine=v810-nec
- os=none
+ basic_os=none
;;
vaxv)
basic_machine=vax-dec
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
vms)
basic_machine=vax-dec
- os=vms
+ basic_os=vms
;;
vsta)
basic_machine=i386-pc
- os=vsta
+ basic_os=vsta
;;
vxworks960)
basic_machine=i960-wrs
- os=vxworks
+ basic_os=vxworks
;;
vxworks68)
basic_machine=m68k-wrs
- os=vxworks
+ basic_os=vxworks
;;
vxworks29k)
basic_machine=a29k-wrs
- os=vxworks
+ basic_os=vxworks
;;
xbox)
basic_machine=i686-pc
- os=mingw32
+ basic_os=mingw32
;;
ymp)
basic_machine=ymp-cray
- os=unicos
+ basic_os=unicos
;;
*)
basic_machine=$1
- os=
+ basic_os=
;;
esac
;;
@@ -683,17 +701,17 @@ case $basic_machine in
bluegene*)
cpu=powerpc
vendor=ibm
- os=cnk
+ basic_os=cnk
;;
decsystem10* | dec10*)
cpu=pdp10
vendor=dec
- os=tops10
+ basic_os=tops10
;;
decsystem20* | dec20*)
cpu=pdp10
vendor=dec
- os=tops20
+ basic_os=tops20
;;
delta | 3300 | motorola-3300 | motorola-delta \
| 3300-motorola | delta-motorola)
@@ -703,7 +721,7 @@ case $basic_machine in
dpx2*)
cpu=m68k
vendor=bull
- os=sysv3
+ basic_os=sysv3
;;
encore | umax | mmax)
cpu=ns32k
@@ -712,7 +730,7 @@ case $basic_machine in
elxsi)
cpu=elxsi
vendor=elxsi
- os=${os:-bsd}
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-bsd}
;;
fx2800)
cpu=i860
@@ -725,7 +743,7 @@ case $basic_machine in
h3050r* | hiux*)
cpu=hppa1.1
vendor=hitachi
- os=hiuxwe2
+ basic_os=hiuxwe2
;;
hp3k9[0-9][0-9] | hp9[0-9][0-9])
cpu=hppa1.0
@@ -768,36 +786,36 @@ case $basic_machine in
i*86v32)
cpu=`echo "$1" | sed -e 's/86.*/86/'`
vendor=pc
- os=sysv32
+ basic_os=sysv32
;;
i*86v4*)
cpu=`echo "$1" | sed -e 's/86.*/86/'`
vendor=pc
- os=sysv4
+ basic_os=sysv4
;;
i*86v)
cpu=`echo "$1" | sed -e 's/86.*/86/'`
vendor=pc
- os=sysv
+ basic_os=sysv
;;
i*86sol2)
cpu=`echo "$1" | sed -e 's/86.*/86/'`
vendor=pc
- os=solaris2
+ basic_os=solaris2
;;
j90 | j90-cray)
cpu=j90
vendor=cray
- os=${os:-unicos}
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-unicos}
;;
iris | iris4d)
cpu=mips
vendor=sgi
- case $os in
+ case $basic_os in
irix*)
;;
*)
- os=irix4
+ basic_os=irix4
;;
esac
;;
@@ -808,26 +826,26 @@ case $basic_machine in
*mint | mint[0-9]* | *MiNT | *MiNT[0-9]*)
cpu=m68k
vendor=atari
- os=mint
+ basic_os=mint
;;
news-3600 | risc-news)
cpu=mips
vendor=sony
- os=newsos
+ basic_os=newsos
;;
next | m*-next)
cpu=m68k
vendor=next
- case $os in
+ case $basic_os in
openstep*)
;;
nextstep*)
;;
ns2*)
- os=nextstep2
+ basic_os=nextstep2
;;
*)
- os=nextstep3
+ basic_os=nextstep3
;;
esac
;;
@@ -838,12 +856,12 @@ case $basic_machine in
op50n-* | op60c-*)
cpu=hppa1.1
vendor=oki
- os=proelf
+ basic_os=proelf
;;
pa-hitachi)
cpu=hppa1.1
vendor=hitachi
- os=hiuxwe2
+ basic_os=hiuxwe2
;;
pbd)
cpu=sparc
@@ -880,12 +898,12 @@ case $basic_machine in
sde)
cpu=mipsisa32
vendor=sde
- os=${os:-elf}
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-elf}
;;
simso-wrs)
cpu=sparclite
vendor=wrs
- os=vxworks
+ basic_os=vxworks
;;
tower | tower-32)
cpu=m68k
@@ -902,7 +920,7 @@ case $basic_machine in
w89k-*)
cpu=hppa1.1
vendor=winbond
- os=proelf
+ basic_os=proelf
;;
none)
cpu=none
@@ -919,9 +937,11 @@ case $basic_machine in
*-*)
# shellcheck disable=SC2162
+ saved_IFS=$IFS
IFS="-" read cpu vendor <<EOF
$basic_machine
EOF
+ IFS=$saved_IFS
;;
# We use `pc' rather than `unknown'
# because (1) that's what they normally are, and
@@ -955,11 +975,11 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
# some cases the only manufacturer, in others, it is the most popular.
craynv-unknown)
vendor=cray
- os=${os:-unicosmp}
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-unicosmp}
;;
c90-unknown | c90-cray)
vendor=cray
- os=${os:-unicos}
+ basic_os=${Basic_os:-unicos}
;;
fx80-unknown)
vendor=alliant
@@ -1000,10 +1020,15 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
;;
# Here we normalize CPU types with a missing or matching vendor
+ armh-unknown | armh-alt)
+ cpu=armv7l
+ vendor=alt
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-linux-gnueabihf}
+ ;;
dpx20-unknown | dpx20-bull)
cpu=rs6000
vendor=bull
- os=${os:-bosx}
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-bosx}
;;
# Here we normalize CPU types irrespective of the vendor
@@ -1012,7 +1037,7 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
;;
blackfin-*)
cpu=bfin
- os=linux
+ basic_os=linux
;;
c54x-*)
cpu=tic54x
@@ -1025,7 +1050,7 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
;;
e500v[12]-*)
cpu=powerpc
- os=$os"spe"
+ basic_os=${basic_os}"spe"
;;
mips3*-*)
cpu=mips64
@@ -1035,7 +1060,7 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
;;
m68knommu-*)
cpu=m68k
- os=linux
+ basic_os=linux
;;
m9s12z-* | m68hcs12z-* | hcs12z-* | s12z-*)
cpu=s12z
@@ -1045,7 +1070,7 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
;;
parisc-*)
cpu=hppa
- os=linux
+ basic_os=linux
;;
pentium-* | p5-* | k5-* | k6-* | nexgen-* | viac3-*)
cpu=i586
@@ -1101,11 +1126,14 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
xscale-* | xscalee[bl]-*)
cpu=`echo "$cpu" | sed 's/^xscale/arm/'`
;;
+ arm64-* | aarch64le-*)
+ cpu=aarch64
+ ;;
# Recognize the canonical CPU Types that limit and/or modify the
# company names they are paired with.
cr16-*)
- os=${os:-elf}
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-elf}
;;
crisv32-* | etraxfs*-*)
cpu=crisv32
@@ -1116,7 +1144,7 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
vendor=axis
;;
crx-*)
- os=${os:-elf}
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-elf}
;;
neo-tandem)
cpu=neo
@@ -1138,16 +1166,12 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
cpu=nsx
vendor=tandem
;;
- s390-*)
- cpu=s390
- vendor=ibm
- ;;
- s390x-*)
- cpu=s390x
- vendor=ibm
+ mipsallegrexel-sony)
+ cpu=mipsallegrexel
+ vendor=sony
;;
tile*-*)
- os=${os:-linux-gnu}
+ basic_os=${basic_os:-linux-gnu}
;;
*)
@@ -1163,8 +1187,8 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
| alphapca5[67] | alpha64pca5[67] \
| am33_2.0 \
| amdgcn \
- | arc | arceb \
- | arm | arm[lb]e | arme[lb] | armv* \
+ | arc | arceb | arc32 | arc64 \
+ | arm | arm[lb]e | arme[lb] | armv* \
| avr | avr32 \
| asmjs \
| ba \
@@ -1183,6 +1207,7 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
| k1om \
| le32 | le64 \
| lm32 \
+ | loongarch32 | loongarch64 | loongarchx32 \
| m32c | m32r | m32rle \
| m5200 | m68000 | m680[012346]0 | m68360 | m683?2 | m68k \
| m6811 | m68hc11 | m6812 | m68hc12 | m68hcs12x \
@@ -1201,9 +1226,13 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
| mips64vr5900 | mips64vr5900el \
| mipsisa32 | mipsisa32el \
| mipsisa32r2 | mipsisa32r2el \
+ | mipsisa32r3 | mipsisa32r3el \
+ | mipsisa32r5 | mipsisa32r5el \
| mipsisa32r6 | mipsisa32r6el \
| mipsisa64 | mipsisa64el \
| mipsisa64r2 | mipsisa64r2el \
+ | mipsisa64r3 | mipsisa64r3el \
+ | mipsisa64r5 | mipsisa64r5el \
| mipsisa64r6 | mipsisa64r6el \
| mipsisa64sb1 | mipsisa64sb1el \
| mipsisa64sr71k | mipsisa64sr71kel \
@@ -1227,8 +1256,9 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
| powerpc | powerpc64 | powerpc64le | powerpcle | powerpcspe \
| pru \
| pyramid \
- | riscv | riscv32 | riscv64 \
+ | riscv | riscv32 | riscv32be | riscv64 | riscv64be \
| rl78 | romp | rs6000 | rx \
+ | s390 | s390x \
| score \
| sh | shl \
| sh[1234] | sh[24]a | sh[24]ae[lb] | sh[23]e | she[lb] | sh[lb]e \
@@ -1238,6 +1268,7 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
| sparcv8 | sparcv9 | sparcv9b | sparcv9v | sv1 | sx* \
| spu \
| tahoe \
+ | thumbv7* \
| tic30 | tic4x | tic54x | tic55x | tic6x | tic80 \
| tron \
| ubicom32 \
@@ -1275,8 +1306,49 @@ esac
# Decode manufacturer-specific aliases for certain operating systems.
-if [ x$os != x ]
+if test x$basic_os != x
then
+
+# First recognize some ad-hoc cases, or perhaps split kernel-os, or else just
+# set os.
+case $basic_os in
+ gnu/linux*)
+ kernel=linux
+ os=`echo "$basic_os" | sed -e 's|gnu/linux|gnu|'`
+ ;;
+ os2-emx)
+ kernel=os2
+ os=`echo "$basic_os" | sed -e 's|os2-emx|emx|'`
+ ;;
+ nto-qnx*)
+ kernel=nto
+ os=`echo "$basic_os" | sed -e 's|nto-qnx|qnx|'`
+ ;;
+ *-*)
+ # shellcheck disable=SC2162
+ saved_IFS=$IFS
+ IFS="-" read kernel os <<EOF
+$basic_os
+EOF
+ IFS=$saved_IFS
+ ;;
+ # Default OS when just kernel was specified
+ nto*)
+ kernel=nto
+ os=`echo "$basic_os" | sed -e 's|nto|qnx|'`
+ ;;
+ linux*)
+ kernel=linux
+ os=`echo "$basic_os" | sed -e 's|linux|gnu|'`
+ ;;
+ *)
+ kernel=
+ os=$basic_os
+ ;;
+esac
+
+# Now, normalize the OS (knowing we just have one component, it's not a kernel,
+# etc.)
case $os in
# First match some system type aliases that might get confused
# with valid system types.
@@ -1288,7 +1360,7 @@ case $os in
os=cnk
;;
solaris1 | solaris1.*)
- os=`echo $os | sed -e 's|solaris1|sunos4|'`
+ os=`echo "$os" | sed -e 's|solaris1|sunos4|'`
;;
solaris)
os=solaris2
@@ -1296,9 +1368,6 @@ case $os in
unixware*)
os=sysv4.2uw
;;
- gnu/linux*)
- os=`echo $os | sed -e 's|gnu/linux|linux-gnu|'`
- ;;
# es1800 is here to avoid being matched by es* (a different OS)
es1800*)
os=ose
@@ -1320,12 +1389,9 @@ case $os in
os=sco3.2v4
;;
sco3.2.[4-9]*)
- os=`echo $os | sed -e 's/sco3.2./sco3.2v/'`
- ;;
- sco3.2v[4-9]* | sco5v6*)
- # Don't forget version if it is 3.2v4 or newer.
+ os=`echo "$os" | sed -e 's/sco3.2./sco3.2v/'`
;;
- scout)
+ sco*v* | scout)
# Don't match below
;;
sco*)
@@ -1334,78 +1400,25 @@ case $os in
psos*)
os=psos
;;
- # Now accept the basic system types.
- # The portable systems comes first.
- # Each alternative MUST end in a * to match a version number.
- # sysv* is not here because it comes later, after sysvr4.
- gnu* | bsd* | mach* | minix* | genix* | ultrix* | irix* \
- | *vms* | esix* | aix* | cnk* | sunos | sunos[34]*\
- | hpux* | unos* | osf* | luna* | dgux* | auroraux* | solaris* \
- | sym* | kopensolaris* | plan9* \
- | amigaos* | amigados* | msdos* | newsos* | unicos* | aof* \
- | aos* | aros* | cloudabi* | sortix* | twizzler* \
- | nindy* | vxsim* | vxworks* | ebmon* | hms* | mvs* \
- | clix* | riscos* | uniplus* | iris* | isc* | rtu* | xenix* \
- | knetbsd* | mirbsd* | netbsd* \
- | bitrig* | openbsd* | solidbsd* | libertybsd* | os108* \
- | ekkobsd* | kfreebsd* | freebsd* | riscix* | lynxos* \
- | bosx* | nextstep* | cxux* | aout* | elf* | oabi* \
- | ptx* | coff* | ecoff* | winnt* | domain* | vsta* \
- | udi* | eabi* | lites* | ieee* | go32* | aux* | hcos* \
- | chorusrdb* | cegcc* | glidix* \
- | cygwin* | msys* | pe* | moss* | proelf* | rtems* \
- | midipix* | mingw32* | mingw64* | linux-gnu* | linux-android* \
- | linux-newlib* | linux-musl* | linux-uclibc* \
- | uxpv* | beos* | mpeix* | udk* | moxiebox* \
- | interix* | uwin* | mks* | rhapsody* | darwin* \
- | openstep* | oskit* | conix* | pw32* | nonstopux* \
- | storm-chaos* | tops10* | tenex* | tops20* | its* \
- | os2* | vos* | palmos* | uclinux* | nucleus* \
- | morphos* | superux* | rtmk* | windiss* \
- | powermax* | dnix* | nx6 | nx7 | sei* | dragonfly* \
- | skyos* | haiku* | rdos* | toppers* | drops* | es* \
- | onefs* | tirtos* | phoenix* | fuchsia* | redox* | bme* \
- | midnightbsd* | amdhsa* | unleashed* | emscripten* | wasi* \
- | nsk* | powerunix* | genode*)
- # Remember, each alternative MUST END IN *, to match a version number.
- ;;
qnx*)
- case $cpu in
- x86 | i*86)
- ;;
- *)
- os=nto-$os
- ;;
- esac
+ os=qnx
;;
hiux*)
os=hiuxwe2
;;
- nto-qnx*)
- ;;
- nto*)
- os=`echo $os | sed -e 's|nto|nto-qnx|'`
- ;;
- sim | xray | os68k* | v88r* \
- | windows* | osx | abug | netware* | os9* \
- | macos* | mpw* | magic* | mmixware* | mon960* | lnews*)
- ;;
- linux-dietlibc)
- os=linux-dietlibc
- ;;
- linux*)
- os=`echo $os | sed -e 's|linux|linux-gnu|'`
- ;;
lynx*178)
os=lynxos178
;;
lynx*5)
os=lynxos5
;;
+ lynxos*)
+ # don't get caught up in next wildcard
+ ;;
lynx*)
os=lynxos
;;
- mac*)
+ mac[0-9]*)
os=`echo "$os" | sed -e 's|mac|macos|'`
;;
opened*)
@@ -1452,7 +1465,7 @@ case $os in
;;
# Preserve the version number of sinix5.
sinix5.*)
- os=`echo $os | sed -e 's|sinix|sysv|'`
+ os=`echo "$os" | sed -e 's|sinix|sysv|'`
;;
sinix*)
os=sysv4
@@ -1475,18 +1488,12 @@ case $os in
sysvr4)
os=sysv4
;;
- # This must come after sysvr4.
- sysv*)
- ;;
ose*)
os=ose
;;
*mint | mint[0-9]* | *MiNT | MiNT[0-9]*)
os=mint
;;
- zvmoe)
- os=zvmoe
- ;;
dicos*)
os=dicos
;;
@@ -1503,19 +1510,11 @@ case $os in
;;
esac
;;
- nacl*)
- ;;
- ios)
- ;;
- none)
- ;;
- *-eabi)
- ;;
*)
- echo Invalid configuration \`"$1"\': system \`"$os"\' not recognized 1>&2
- exit 1
+ # No normalization, but not necessarily accepted, that comes below.
;;
esac
+
else
# Here we handle the default operating systems that come with various machines.
@@ -1528,6 +1527,7 @@ else
# will signal an error saying that MANUFACTURER isn't an operating
# system, and we'll never get to this point.
+kernel=
case $cpu-$vendor in
score-*)
os=elf
@@ -1539,7 +1539,8 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
os=riscix1.2
;;
arm*-rebel)
- os=linux
+ kernel=linux
+ os=gnu
;;
arm*-semi)
os=aout
@@ -1705,84 +1706,180 @@ case $cpu-$vendor in
os=none
;;
esac
+
fi
+# Now, validate our (potentially fixed-up) OS.
+case $os in
+ # Sometimes we do "kernel-libc", so those need to count as OSes.
+ musl* | newlib* | relibc* | uclibc*)
+ ;;
+ # Likewise for "kernel-abi"
+ eabi* | gnueabi*)
+ ;;
+ # VxWorks passes extra cpu info in the 4th filed.
+ simlinux | simwindows | spe)
+ ;;
+ # Now accept the basic system types.
+ # The portable systems comes first.
+ # Each alternative MUST end in a * to match a version number.
+ gnu* | android* | bsd* | mach* | minix* | genix* | ultrix* | irix* \
+ | *vms* | esix* | aix* | cnk* | sunos | sunos[34]* \
+ | hpux* | unos* | osf* | luna* | dgux* | auroraux* | solaris* \
+ | sym* | plan9* | psp* | sim* | xray* | os68k* | v88r* \
+ | hiux* | abug | nacl* | netware* | windows* \
+ | os9* | macos* | osx* | ios* \
+ | mpw* | magic* | mmixware* | mon960* | lnews* \
+ | amigaos* | amigados* | msdos* | newsos* | unicos* | aof* \
+ | aos* | aros* | cloudabi* | sortix* | twizzler* \
+ | nindy* | vxsim* | vxworks* | ebmon* | hms* | mvs* \
+ | clix* | riscos* | uniplus* | iris* | isc* | rtu* | xenix* \
+ | mirbsd* | netbsd* | dicos* | openedition* | ose* \
+ | bitrig* | openbsd* | secbsd* | solidbsd* | libertybsd* | os108* \
+ | ekkobsd* | freebsd* | riscix* | lynxos* | os400* \
+ | bosx* | nextstep* | cxux* | aout* | elf* | oabi* \
+ | ptx* | coff* | ecoff* | winnt* | domain* | vsta* \
+ | udi* | lites* | ieee* | go32* | aux* | hcos* \
+ | chorusrdb* | cegcc* | glidix* | serenity* \
+ | cygwin* | msys* | pe* | moss* | proelf* | rtems* \
+ | midipix* | mingw32* | mingw64* | mint* \
+ | uxpv* | beos* | mpeix* | udk* | moxiebox* \
+ | interix* | uwin* | mks* | rhapsody* | darwin* \
+ | openstep* | oskit* | conix* | pw32* | nonstopux* \
+ | storm-chaos* | tops10* | tenex* | tops20* | its* \
+ | os2* | vos* | palmos* | uclinux* | nucleus* | morphos* \
+ | scout* | superux* | sysv* | rtmk* | tpf* | windiss* \
+ | powermax* | dnix* | nx6 | nx7 | sei* | dragonfly* \
+ | skyos* | haiku* | rdos* | toppers* | drops* | es* \
+ | onefs* | tirtos* | phoenix* | fuchsia* | redox* | bme* \
+ | midnightbsd* | amdhsa* | unleashed* | emscripten* | wasi* \
+ | nsk* | powerunix* | genode* | zvmoe* | qnx* | emx* | zephyr* \
+ | fiwix* )
+ ;;
+ # This one is extra strict with allowed versions
+ sco3.2v2 | sco3.2v[4-9]* | sco5v6*)
+ # Don't forget version if it is 3.2v4 or newer.
+ ;;
+ none)
+ ;;
+ *)
+ echo Invalid configuration \`"$1"\': OS \`"$os"\' not recognized 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+esac
+
+# As a final step for OS-related things, validate the OS-kernel combination
+# (given a valid OS), if there is a kernel.
+case $kernel-$os in
+ linux-gnu* | linux-dietlibc* | linux-android* | linux-newlib* \
+ | linux-musl* | linux-relibc* | linux-uclibc* )
+ ;;
+ uclinux-uclibc* )
+ ;;
+ -dietlibc* | -newlib* | -musl* | -relibc* | -uclibc* )
+ # These are just libc implementations, not actual OSes, and thus
+ # require a kernel.
+ echo "Invalid configuration \`$1': libc \`$os' needs explicit kernel." 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+ kfreebsd*-gnu* | kopensolaris*-gnu*)
+ ;;
+ vxworks-simlinux | vxworks-simwindows | vxworks-spe)
+ ;;
+ nto-qnx*)
+ ;;
+ os2-emx)
+ ;;
+ *-eabi* | *-gnueabi*)
+ ;;
+ -*)
+ # Blank kernel with real OS is always fine.
+ ;;
+ *-*)
+ echo "Invalid configuration \`$1': Kernel \`$kernel' not known to work with OS \`$os'." 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+esac
+
# Here we handle the case where we know the os, and the CPU type, but not the
# manufacturer. We pick the logical manufacturer.
case $vendor in
unknown)
- case $os in
- riscix*)
+ case $cpu-$os in
+ *-riscix*)
vendor=acorn
;;
- sunos*)
+ *-sunos*)
vendor=sun
;;
- cnk*|-aix*)
+ *-cnk* | *-aix*)
vendor=ibm
;;
- beos*)
+ *-beos*)
vendor=be
;;
- hpux*)
+ *-hpux*)
vendor=hp
;;
- mpeix*)
+ *-mpeix*)
vendor=hp
;;
- hiux*)
+ *-hiux*)
vendor=hitachi
;;
- unos*)
+ *-unos*)
vendor=crds
;;
- dgux*)
+ *-dgux*)
vendor=dg
;;
- luna*)
+ *-luna*)
vendor=omron
;;
- genix*)
+ *-genix*)
vendor=ns
;;
- clix*)
+ *-clix*)
vendor=intergraph
;;
- mvs* | opened*)
+ *-mvs* | *-opened*)
+ vendor=ibm
+ ;;
+ *-os400*)
vendor=ibm
;;
- os400*)
+ s390-* | s390x-*)
vendor=ibm
;;
- ptx*)
+ *-ptx*)
vendor=sequent
;;
- tpf*)
+ *-tpf*)
vendor=ibm
;;
- vxsim* | vxworks* | windiss*)
+ *-vxsim* | *-vxworks* | *-windiss*)
vendor=wrs
;;
- aux*)
+ *-aux*)
vendor=apple
;;
- hms*)
+ *-hms*)
vendor=hitachi
;;
- mpw* | macos*)
+ *-mpw* | *-macos*)
vendor=apple
;;
- *mint | mint[0-9]* | *MiNT | MiNT[0-9]*)
+ *-*mint | *-mint[0-9]* | *-*MiNT | *-MiNT[0-9]*)
vendor=atari
;;
- vos*)
+ *-vos*)
vendor=stratus
;;
esac
;;
esac
-echo "$cpu-$vendor-$os"
+echo "$cpu-$vendor-${kernel:+$kernel-}$os"
exit
# Local variables:
diff --git a/build-aux/depcomp b/build-aux/depcomp
index 6b391623..75323b73 100755
--- a/build-aux/depcomp
+++ b/build-aux/depcomp
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
scriptversion=2018-03-07.03; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 1999-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 1999-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
@@ -113,7 +113,6 @@ nl='
# These definitions help.
upper=ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
lower=abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
-digits=0123456789
alpha=${upper}${lower}
if test -z "$depmode" || test -z "$source" || test -z "$object"; then
diff --git a/build-aux/gitlog-to-changelog b/build-aux/gitlog-to-changelog
index be8082e7..82d9f973 100755
--- a/build-aux/gitlog-to-changelog
+++ b/build-aux/gitlog-to-changelog
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
# Convert git log output to ChangeLog format.
-# Copyright (C) 2008-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 2008-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
#
# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
@@ -35,7 +35,7 @@
eval 'exec perl -wSx "$0" "$@"'
if 0;
-my $VERSION = '2020-04-04 15:07'; # UTC
+my $VERSION = '2022-01-27 18:49'; # UTC
# The definition above must lie within the first 8 lines in order
# for the Emacs time-stamp write hook (at end) to update it.
# If you change this file with Emacs, please let the write hook
@@ -455,7 +455,8 @@ sub git_dir_option($)
# If there were any lines
if (@line == 0)
{
- warn "$ME: warning: empty commit message:\n $date_line\n";
+ warn "$ME: warning: empty commit message:\n"
+ . " commit $sha\n $date_line\n";
}
else
{
diff --git a/build-aux/gnupload b/build-aux/gnupload
index e4ea5427..b97e566f 100755
--- a/build-aux/gnupload
+++ b/build-aux/gnupload
@@ -1,13 +1,13 @@
#!/bin/sh
# Sign files and upload them.
-scriptversion=2018-05-19.18; # UTC
+scriptversion=2022-01-27.18; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 2004-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 2004-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
#
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
# any later version.
#
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -27,8 +27,8 @@ set -e
GPG=gpg
# Choose the proper version of gpg, so as to avoid a
# "gpg-agent is not available in this session" error
-# when gpg-agent is version 3 but gpg is still version 1.
-# FIXME-2020: remove, once all major distros ship gpg version 3 as /usr/bin/gpg
+# when gpg-agent is version 2 but gpg is still version 1.
+# FIXME-2020: remove, once all major distros ship gpg version 2 as /usr/bin/gpg
gpg_agent_version=`(gpg-agent --version) 2>/dev/null | sed -e '2,$d' -e 's/^[^0-9]*//'`
case "$gpg_agent_version" in
2.*)
@@ -145,6 +145,12 @@ the build-aux/ directory of the gnulib package
Send patches and bug reports to <bug-gnulib@gnu.org>."
+copyright_year=`echo "$scriptversion" | sed -e 's/[^0-9].*//'`
+copyright="Copyright (C) ${copyright_year} Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+License GPLv2+: GNU GPL version 2 or later <https://gnu.org/licenses/gpl.html>.
+This is free software: you are free to change and redistribute it.
+There is NO WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law."
+
# Read local configuration file
if test -r "$conffile"; then
echo "$0: Reading configuration file $conffile"
@@ -209,7 +215,8 @@ while test -n "$1"; do
;;
--version)
echo "gnupload $scriptversion"
- exit $?
+ echo "$copyright"
+ exit 0
;;
--)
shift
diff --git a/build-aux/install-sh b/build-aux/install-sh
index 20d8b2ea..ec298b53 100755
--- a/build-aux/install-sh
+++ b/build-aux/install-sh
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
#!/bin/sh
# install - install a program, script, or datafile
-scriptversion=2018-03-11.20; # UTC
+scriptversion=2020-11-14.01; # UTC
# This originates from X11R5 (mit/util/scripts/install.sh), which was
# later released in X11R6 (xc/config/util/install.sh) with the
@@ -69,6 +69,11 @@ posix_mkdir=
# Desired mode of installed file.
mode=0755
+# Create dirs (including intermediate dirs) using mode 755.
+# This is like GNU 'install' as of coreutils 8.32 (2020).
+mkdir_umask=22
+
+backupsuffix=
chgrpcmd=
chmodcmd=$chmodprog
chowncmd=
@@ -99,18 +104,28 @@ Options:
--version display version info and exit.
-c (ignored)
- -C install only if different (preserve the last data modification time)
+ -C install only if different (preserve data modification time)
-d create directories instead of installing files.
-g GROUP $chgrpprog installed files to GROUP.
-m MODE $chmodprog installed files to MODE.
-o USER $chownprog installed files to USER.
+ -p pass -p to $cpprog.
-s $stripprog installed files.
+ -S SUFFIX attempt to back up existing files, with suffix SUFFIX.
-t DIRECTORY install into DIRECTORY.
-T report an error if DSTFILE is a directory.
Environment variables override the default commands:
CHGRPPROG CHMODPROG CHOWNPROG CMPPROG CPPROG MKDIRPROG MVPROG
RMPROG STRIPPROG
+
+By default, rm is invoked with -f; when overridden with RMPROG,
+it's up to you to specify -f if you want it.
+
+If -S is not specified, no backups are attempted.
+
+Email bug reports to bug-automake@gnu.org.
+Automake home page: https://www.gnu.org/software/automake/
"
while test $# -ne 0; do
@@ -137,8 +152,13 @@ while test $# -ne 0; do
-o) chowncmd="$chownprog $2"
shift;;
+ -p) cpprog="$cpprog -p";;
+
-s) stripcmd=$stripprog;;
+ -S) backupsuffix="$2"
+ shift;;
+
-t)
is_target_a_directory=always
dst_arg=$2
@@ -255,6 +275,10 @@ do
dstdir=$dst
test -d "$dstdir"
dstdir_status=$?
+ # Don't chown directories that already exist.
+ if test $dstdir_status = 0; then
+ chowncmd=""
+ fi
else
# Waiting for this to be detected by the "$cpprog $src $dsttmp" command
@@ -301,22 +325,6 @@ do
if test $dstdir_status != 0; then
case $posix_mkdir in
'')
- # Create intermediate dirs using mode 755 as modified by the umask.
- # This is like FreeBSD 'install' as of 1997-10-28.
- umask=`umask`
- case $stripcmd.$umask in
- # Optimize common cases.
- *[2367][2367]) mkdir_umask=$umask;;
- .*0[02][02] | .[02][02] | .[02]) mkdir_umask=22;;
-
- *[0-7])
- mkdir_umask=`expr $umask + 22 \
- - $umask % 100 % 40 + $umask % 20 \
- - $umask % 10 % 4 + $umask % 2
- `;;
- *) mkdir_umask=$umask,go-w;;
- esac
-
# With -d, create the new directory with the user-specified mode.
# Otherwise, rely on $mkdir_umask.
if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
@@ -326,52 +334,49 @@ do
fi
posix_mkdir=false
- case $umask in
- *[123567][0-7][0-7])
- # POSIX mkdir -p sets u+wx bits regardless of umask, which
- # is incompatible with FreeBSD 'install' when (umask & 300) != 0.
- ;;
- *)
- # Note that $RANDOM variable is not portable (e.g. dash); Use it
- # here however when possible just to lower collision chance.
- tmpdir=${TMPDIR-/tmp}/ins$RANDOM-$$
-
- trap 'ret=$?; rmdir "$tmpdir/a/b" "$tmpdir/a" "$tmpdir" 2>/dev/null; exit $ret' 0
-
- # Because "mkdir -p" follows existing symlinks and we likely work
- # directly in world-writeable /tmp, make sure that the '$tmpdir'
- # directory is successfully created first before we actually test
- # 'mkdir -p' feature.
- if (umask $mkdir_umask &&
- $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode "$tmpdir" &&
- exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$tmpdir/a/b") >/dev/null 2>&1
- then
- if test -z "$dir_arg" || {
- # Check for POSIX incompatibilities with -m.
- # HP-UX 11.23 and IRIX 6.5 mkdir -m -p sets group- or
- # other-writable bit of parent directory when it shouldn't.
- # FreeBSD 6.1 mkdir -m -p sets mode of existing directory.
- test_tmpdir="$tmpdir/a"
- ls_ld_tmpdir=`ls -ld "$test_tmpdir"`
- case $ls_ld_tmpdir in
- d????-?r-*) different_mode=700;;
- d????-?--*) different_mode=755;;
- *) false;;
- esac &&
- $mkdirprog -m$different_mode -p -- "$test_tmpdir" && {
- ls_ld_tmpdir_1=`ls -ld "$test_tmpdir"`
- test "$ls_ld_tmpdir" = "$ls_ld_tmpdir_1"
- }
- }
- then posix_mkdir=:
- fi
- rmdir "$tmpdir/a/b" "$tmpdir/a" "$tmpdir"
- else
- # Remove any dirs left behind by ancient mkdir implementations.
- rmdir ./$mkdir_mode ./-p ./-- "$tmpdir" 2>/dev/null
- fi
- trap '' 0;;
- esac;;
+ # The $RANDOM variable is not portable (e.g., dash). Use it
+ # here however when possible just to lower collision chance.
+ tmpdir=${TMPDIR-/tmp}/ins$RANDOM-$$
+
+ trap '
+ ret=$?
+ rmdir "$tmpdir/a/b" "$tmpdir/a" "$tmpdir" 2>/dev/null
+ exit $ret
+ ' 0
+
+ # Because "mkdir -p" follows existing symlinks and we likely work
+ # directly in world-writeable /tmp, make sure that the '$tmpdir'
+ # directory is successfully created first before we actually test
+ # 'mkdir -p'.
+ if (umask $mkdir_umask &&
+ $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode "$tmpdir" &&
+ exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$tmpdir/a/b") >/dev/null 2>&1
+ then
+ if test -z "$dir_arg" || {
+ # Check for POSIX incompatibilities with -m.
+ # HP-UX 11.23 and IRIX 6.5 mkdir -m -p sets group- or
+ # other-writable bit of parent directory when it shouldn't.
+ # FreeBSD 6.1 mkdir -m -p sets mode of existing directory.
+ test_tmpdir="$tmpdir/a"
+ ls_ld_tmpdir=`ls -ld "$test_tmpdir"`
+ case $ls_ld_tmpdir in
+ d????-?r-*) different_mode=700;;
+ d????-?--*) different_mode=755;;
+ *) false;;
+ esac &&
+ $mkdirprog -m$different_mode -p -- "$test_tmpdir" && {
+ ls_ld_tmpdir_1=`ls -ld "$test_tmpdir"`
+ test "$ls_ld_tmpdir" = "$ls_ld_tmpdir_1"
+ }
+ }
+ then posix_mkdir=:
+ fi
+ rmdir "$tmpdir/a/b" "$tmpdir/a" "$tmpdir"
+ else
+ # Remove any dirs left behind by ancient mkdir implementations.
+ rmdir ./$mkdir_mode ./-p ./-- "$tmpdir" 2>/dev/null
+ fi
+ trap '' 0;;
esac
if
@@ -382,7 +387,7 @@ do
then :
else
- # The umask is ridiculous, or mkdir does not conform to POSIX,
+ # mkdir does not conform to POSIX,
# or it failed possibly due to a race condition. Create the
# directory the slow way, step by step, checking for races as we go.
@@ -411,7 +416,7 @@ do
prefixes=
else
if $posix_mkdir; then
- (umask=$mkdir_umask &&
+ (umask $mkdir_umask &&
$doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir") && break
# Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently.
test -d "$prefix" || exit 1
@@ -488,6 +493,13 @@ do
then
rm -f "$dsttmp"
else
+ # If $backupsuffix is set, and the file being installed
+ # already exists, attempt a backup. Don't worry if it fails,
+ # e.g., if mv doesn't support -f.
+ if test -n "$backupsuffix" && test -f "$dst"; then
+ $doit $mvcmd -f "$dst" "$dst$backupsuffix" 2>/dev/null
+ fi
+
# Rename the file to the real destination.
$doit $mvcmd -f "$dsttmp" "$dst" 2>/dev/null ||
@@ -502,9 +514,9 @@ do
# file should still install successfully.
{
test ! -f "$dst" ||
- $doit $rmcmd -f "$dst" 2>/dev/null ||
+ $doit $rmcmd "$dst" 2>/dev/null ||
{ $doit $mvcmd -f "$dst" "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null &&
- { $doit $rmcmd -f "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null; :; }
+ { $doit $rmcmd "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null; :; }
} ||
{ echo "$0: cannot unlink or rename $dst" >&2
(exit 1); exit 1
diff --git a/build-aux/ltmain.sh b/build-aux/ltmain.sh
index f402c9c1..21e5e078 100644..100755
--- a/build-aux/ltmain.sh
+++ b/build-aux/ltmain.sh
@@ -31,7 +31,7 @@
PROGRAM=libtool
PACKAGE=libtool
-VERSION="2.4.6 Debian-2.4.6-10"
+VERSION="2.4.6 Debian-2.4.6-15"
package_revision=2.4.6
@@ -387,7 +387,7 @@ EXIT_SKIP=77 # $? = 77 is used to indicate a skipped test to automake.
# putting '$debug_cmd' at the start of all your functions, you can get
# bash to show function call trace with:
#
-# debug_cmd='eval echo "${FUNCNAME[0]} $*" >&2' bash your-script-name
+# debug_cmd='echo "${FUNCNAME[0]} $*" >&2' bash your-script-name
debug_cmd=${debug_cmd-":"}
exit_cmd=:
@@ -2141,7 +2141,7 @@ include the following information:
compiler: $LTCC
compiler flags: $LTCFLAGS
linker: $LD (gnu? $with_gnu_ld)
- version: $progname $scriptversion Debian-2.4.6-10
+ version: $progname $scriptversion Debian-2.4.6-15
automake: `($AUTOMAKE --version) 2>/dev/null |$SED 1q`
autoconf: `($AUTOCONF --version) 2>/dev/null |$SED 1q`
@@ -7368,10 +7368,12 @@ func_mode_link ()
# -stdlib=* select c++ std lib with clang
# -fsanitize=* Clang/GCC memory and address sanitizer
# -fuse-ld=* Linker select flags for GCC
+ # -static-* direct GCC to link specific libraries statically
+ # -fcilkplus Cilk Plus language extension features for C/C++
-64|-mips[0-9]|-r[0-9][0-9]*|-xarch=*|-xtarget=*|+DA*|+DD*|-q*|-m*| \
-t[45]*|-txscale*|-p|-pg|--coverage|-fprofile-*|-F*|@*|-tp=*|--sysroot=*| \
-O*|-g*|-flto*|-fwhopr*|-fuse-linker-plugin|-fstack-protector*|-stdlib=*| \
- -specs=*|-fsanitize=*|-fuse-ld=*)
+ -specs=*|-fsanitize=*|-fuse-ld=*|-static-*|-fcilkplus)
func_quote_for_eval "$arg"
arg=$func_quote_for_eval_result
func_append compile_command " $arg"
diff --git a/build-aux/mdate-sh b/build-aux/mdate-sh
deleted file mode 100755
index 6a6a4bcf..00000000
--- a/build-aux/mdate-sh
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,228 +0,0 @@
-#!/bin/sh
-# Get modification time of a file or directory and pretty-print it.
-
-scriptversion=2018-03-07.03; # UTC
-
-# Copyright (C) 1995-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-# written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, June 1995
-#
-# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-# any later version.
-#
-# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-# GNU General Public License for more details.
-#
-# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program. If not, see <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
-
-# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
-# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
-# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
-# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
-
-# This file is maintained in Automake, please report
-# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
-# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
-
-if test -n "${ZSH_VERSION+set}" && (emulate sh) >/dev/null 2>&1; then
- emulate sh
- NULLCMD=:
- # Pre-4.2 versions of Zsh do word splitting on ${1+"$@"}, which
- # is contrary to our usage. Disable this feature.
- alias -g '${1+"$@"}'='"$@"'
- setopt NO_GLOB_SUBST
-fi
-
-case $1 in
- '')
- echo "$0: No file. Try '$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
- exit 1;
- ;;
- -h | --h*)
- cat <<\EOF
-Usage: mdate-sh [--help] [--version] FILE
-
-Pretty-print the modification day of FILE, in the format:
-1 January 1970
-
-Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>.
-EOF
- exit $?
- ;;
- -v | --v*)
- echo "mdate-sh $scriptversion"
- exit $?
- ;;
-esac
-
-error ()
-{
- echo "$0: $1" >&2
- exit 1
-}
-
-
-# Prevent date giving response in another language.
-LANG=C
-export LANG
-LC_ALL=C
-export LC_ALL
-LC_TIME=C
-export LC_TIME
-
-# Use UTC to get reproducible result.
-TZ=UTC0
-export TZ
-
-# GNU ls changes its time format in response to the TIME_STYLE
-# variable. Since we cannot assume 'unset' works, revert this
-# variable to its documented default.
-if test "${TIME_STYLE+set}" = set; then
- TIME_STYLE=posix-long-iso
- export TIME_STYLE
-fi
-
-save_arg1=$1
-
-# Find out how to get the extended ls output of a file or directory.
-if ls -L /dev/null 1>/dev/null 2>&1; then
- ls_command='ls -L -l -d'
-else
- ls_command='ls -l -d'
-fi
-# Avoid user/group names that might have spaces, when possible.
-if ls -n /dev/null 1>/dev/null 2>&1; then
- ls_command="$ls_command -n"
-fi
-
-# A 'ls -l' line looks as follows on OS/2.
-# drwxrwx--- 0 Aug 11 2001 foo
-# This differs from Unix, which adds ownership information.
-# drwxrwx--- 2 root root 4096 Aug 11 2001 foo
-#
-# To find the date, we split the line on spaces and iterate on words
-# until we find a month. This cannot work with files whose owner is a
-# user named "Jan", or "Feb", etc. However, it's unlikely that '/'
-# will be owned by a user whose name is a month. So we first look at
-# the extended ls output of the root directory to decide how many
-# words should be skipped to get the date.
-
-# On HPUX /bin/sh, "set" interprets "-rw-r--r--" as options, so the "x" below.
-set x`$ls_command /`
-
-# Find which argument is the month.
-month=
-command=
-until test $month
-do
- test $# -gt 0 || error "failed parsing '$ls_command /' output"
- shift
- # Add another shift to the command.
- command="$command shift;"
- case $1 in
- Jan) month=January; nummonth=1;;
- Feb) month=February; nummonth=2;;
- Mar) month=March; nummonth=3;;
- Apr) month=April; nummonth=4;;
- May) month=May; nummonth=5;;
- Jun) month=June; nummonth=6;;
- Jul) month=July; nummonth=7;;
- Aug) month=August; nummonth=8;;
- Sep) month=September; nummonth=9;;
- Oct) month=October; nummonth=10;;
- Nov) month=November; nummonth=11;;
- Dec) month=December; nummonth=12;;
- esac
-done
-
-test -n "$month" || error "failed parsing '$ls_command /' output"
-
-# Get the extended ls output of the file or directory.
-set dummy x`eval "$ls_command \"\\\$save_arg1\""`
-
-# Remove all preceding arguments
-eval $command
-
-# Because of the dummy argument above, month is in $2.
-#
-# On a POSIX system, we should have
-#
-# $# = 5
-# $1 = file size
-# $2 = month
-# $3 = day
-# $4 = year or time
-# $5 = filename
-#
-# On Darwin 7.7.0 and 7.6.0, we have
-#
-# $# = 4
-# $1 = day
-# $2 = month
-# $3 = year or time
-# $4 = filename
-
-# Get the month.
-case $2 in
- Jan) month=January; nummonth=1;;
- Feb) month=February; nummonth=2;;
- Mar) month=March; nummonth=3;;
- Apr) month=April; nummonth=4;;
- May) month=May; nummonth=5;;
- Jun) month=June; nummonth=6;;
- Jul) month=July; nummonth=7;;
- Aug) month=August; nummonth=8;;
- Sep) month=September; nummonth=9;;
- Oct) month=October; nummonth=10;;
- Nov) month=November; nummonth=11;;
- Dec) month=December; nummonth=12;;
-esac
-
-case $3 in
- ???*) day=$1;;
- *) day=$3; shift;;
-esac
-
-# Here we have to deal with the problem that the ls output gives either
-# the time of day or the year.
-case $3 in
- *:*) set `date`; eval year=\$$#
- case $2 in
- Jan) nummonthtod=1;;
- Feb) nummonthtod=2;;
- Mar) nummonthtod=3;;
- Apr) nummonthtod=4;;
- May) nummonthtod=5;;
- Jun) nummonthtod=6;;
- Jul) nummonthtod=7;;
- Aug) nummonthtod=8;;
- Sep) nummonthtod=9;;
- Oct) nummonthtod=10;;
- Nov) nummonthtod=11;;
- Dec) nummonthtod=12;;
- esac
- # For the first six month of the year the time notation can also
- # be used for files modified in the last year.
- if (expr $nummonth \> $nummonthtod) > /dev/null;
- then
- year=`expr $year - 1`
- fi;;
- *) year=$3;;
-esac
-
-# The result.
-echo $day $month $year
-
-# Local Variables:
-# mode: shell-script
-# sh-indentation: 2
-# eval: (add-hook 'before-save-hook 'time-stamp)
-# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
-# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
-# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
-# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/missing b/build-aux/missing
index 8d0eaad2..1fe1611f 100755
--- a/build-aux/missing
+++ b/build-aux/missing
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
scriptversion=2018-03-07.03; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 1996-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# Originally written by Fran,cois Pinard <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>, 1996.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
diff --git a/build-aux/test-driver b/build-aux/test-driver
index 9759384a..be73b80a 100755
--- a/build-aux/test-driver
+++ b/build-aux/test-driver
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
scriptversion=2018-03-07.03; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 2011-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 2011-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
#
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
@@ -105,8 +105,11 @@ trap "st=130; $do_exit" 2
trap "st=141; $do_exit" 13
trap "st=143; $do_exit" 15
-# Test script is run here.
-"$@" >$log_file 2>&1
+# Test script is run here. We create the file first, then append to it,
+# to ameliorate tests themselves also writing to the log file. Our tests
+# don't, but others can (automake bug#35762).
+: >"$log_file"
+"$@" >>"$log_file" 2>&1
estatus=$?
if test $enable_hard_errors = no && test $estatus -eq 99; then
@@ -128,7 +131,7 @@ esac
# know whether the test passed or failed simply by looking at the '.log'
# file, without the need of also peaking into the corresponding '.trs'
# file (automake bug#11814).
-echo "$res $test_name (exit status: $estatus)" >>$log_file
+echo "$res $test_name (exit status: $estatus)" >>"$log_file"
# Report outcome to console.
echo "${col}${res}${std}: $test_name"
diff --git a/build-aux/texinfo.tex b/build-aux/texinfo.tex
deleted file mode 100644
index d3136db3..00000000
--- a/build-aux/texinfo.tex
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,11707 +0,0 @@
-% texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
-%
-% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
-\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
-%
-\def\texinfoversion{2020-05-22.11}
-%
-% Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-%
-% This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
-% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
-% published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
-% License, or (at your option) any later version.
-%
-% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
-% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
-% of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
-% General Public License for more details.
-%
-% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-% along with this program. If not, see <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
-%
-% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
-% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
-% restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
-% of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
-%
-% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
-% reports; you can get the latest version from:
-% https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
-% https://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
-% https://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
-% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
-% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
-%
-% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include a
-% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
-% problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
-%
-% To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
-% texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
-% manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
-% tex foo.texi
-% texindex foo.??
-% tex foo.texi
-% tex foo.texi
-% dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
-% The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
-% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
-% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
-%
-% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
-% extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
-% full Texinfo distribution.
-%
-% The GNU Texinfo home page is https://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
-
-
-\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
-
-% If in a .fmt file, print the version number
-% and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
-% they might have appeared in the input file name.
-\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
- \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
-
-% LaTeX's \typeout. This ensures that the messages it is used for
-% are identical in format to the corresponding ones from latex/pdflatex.
-\def\typeout{\immediate\write17}%
-
-\chardef\other=12
-
-% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
-% For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
-\let\+ = \relax
-
-% Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
-\let\ptexb=\b
-\let\ptexbullet=\bullet
-\let\ptexc=\c
-\let\ptexcomma=\,
-\let\ptexdot=\.
-\let\ptexdots=\dots
-\let\ptexend=\end
-\let\ptexequiv=\equiv
-\let\ptexexclam=\!
-\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
-\let\ptexgtr=>
-\let\ptexhat=^
-\let\ptexi=\i
-\let\ptexindent=\indent
-\let\ptexinsert=\insert
-\let\ptexlbrace=\{
-\let\ptexless=<
-\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
-\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
-\let\ptexplus=+
-\let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
-\let\ptexrbrace=\}
-\let\ptexslash=\/
-\let\ptexsp=\sp
-\let\ptexstar=\*
-\let\ptexsup=\sup
-\let\ptext=\t
-\let\ptextop=\top
-{\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode
-
-% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
-% starts a new line in the output.
-\newlinechar = `^^J
-
-% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
-% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
-%
-\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
- \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
-\else
- \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
-\fi
-
-% Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
-\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
-\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
-\ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi
-\ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
-\ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
-\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
-\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
-\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
-\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
-\ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
-\ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
-\ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
-\ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
-\ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
-\ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
-\ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
-\ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
-\ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
-\ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
-%
-\ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
-%
-\ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
-
-% Give the space character the catcode for a space.
-\def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =10\relax}
-
-% Likewise for ^^M, the end of line character.
-\def\endlineisspace{\catcode13=10\relax}
-
-\chardef\dashChar = `\-
-\chardef\slashChar = `\/
-\chardef\underChar = `\_
-
-% Ignore a token.
-%
-\def\gobble#1{}
-
-% The following is used inside several \edef's.
-\def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
-
-% Hyphenation fixes.
-\hyphenation{
- Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
- ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
- data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
- man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
- par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
- spell-ing spell-ings
- stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
- wide-spread wrap-around
-}
-
-% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
-% and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
-% since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
-% some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
-% file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
-%
-\def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
-\def\loggingall{%
- \tracingstats2
- \tracingpages1
- \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
- \tracingparagraphs1
- \tracingoutput1
- \tracingmacros2
- \tracingrestores1
- \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
- \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
- \tracingscantokens1
- \tracingifs1
- \tracinggroups1
- \tracingnesting2
- \tracingassigns1
- \fi
- \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
- \errorcontextlines16
-}%
-
-% @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
-% aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
-% after all.
-%
-\def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
-\def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
-
-% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
-% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
-%
-\def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
- \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
-\def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
- \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
-\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
- \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
-
-% Output routine
-%
-
-% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
-% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
-% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
-%
-\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt }
-
-\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
-\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
-
-% Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
-% We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
-% This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
-%
-% A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
-% \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
-%
-% Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
-% (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
-% of a page, or that at the bottom of a page.
-
-% \domark is called twice inside \chapmacro, to add one
-% mark before the section break, and one after.
-% In the second call \prevchapterdefs is the same as \currentchapterdefs,
-% and \prevsectiondefs is the same as \currentsectiondefs.
-% Then if the page is not broken at the mark, some of the previous
-% section appears on the page, and we can get the name of this section
-% from \firstmark for @everyheadingmarks top.
-% @everyheadingmarks bottom uses \botmark.
-%
-% See page 260 of The TeXbook.
-\def\domark{%
- \toks0=\expandafter{\currentchapterdefs}%
- \toks2=\expandafter{\currentsectiondefs}%
- \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
- \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
- \toks8=\expandafter{\currentcolordefs}%
- \mark{%
- \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: marks for @everyheadingmarks top
- \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: for @everyheadingmarks bottom
- \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks
- }%
-}
-
-% \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks,
-% \getcolormarks - extract needed part of mark.
-%
-% \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
-% page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
-% the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
-% @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
-% first @chapter.
-\def\gettopheadingmarks{%
- \ifcase0\the\savedtopmark\fi
- \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
-}
-\def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
-\def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\the\savedtopmark\fi}
-
-% Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
-\def\currentchapterdefs{}
-\def\currentsectiondefs{}
-\def\currentsection{}
-\def\prevchapterdefs{}
-\def\prevsectiondefs{}
-\def\currentcolordefs{}
-
-% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
-\newdimen\bindingoffset
-\newdimen\normaloffset
-\newdimen\txipagewidth \newdimen\txipageheight
-
-% Main output routine.
-%
-\chardef\PAGE = 255
-\newtoks\defaultoutput
-\defaultoutput = {\savetopmark\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
-\output=\expandafter{\the\defaultoutput}
-
-\newbox\headlinebox
-\newbox\footlinebox
-
-% When outputting the double column layout for indices, an output routine
-% is run several times, which hides the original value of \topmark. This
-% can lead to a page heading being output and duplicating the chapter heading
-% of the index. Hence, save the contents of \topmark at the beginning of
-% the output routine. The saved contents are valid until we actually
-% \shipout a page.
-%
-% (We used to run a short output routine to actually set \topmark and
-% \firstmark to the right values, but if this was called with an empty page
-% containing whatsits for writing index entries, the whatsits would be thrown
-% away and the index auxiliary file would remain empty.)
-%
-\newtoks\savedtopmark
-\newif\iftopmarksaved
-\topmarksavedtrue
-\def\savetopmark{%
- \iftopmarksaved\else
- \global\savedtopmark=\expandafter{\topmark}%
- \global\topmarksavedtrue
- \fi
-}
-
-% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument.
-% \shipout a vbox for a single page, adding an optional header, footer
-% and footnote. This also causes index entries for this page to be written
-% to the auxiliary files.
-%
-\def\onepageout#1{%
- \hoffset=\normaloffset
- %
- \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
- \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
- %
- \checkchapterpage
- %
- % Retrieve the information for the headings from the marks in the page,
- % and call Plain TeX's \makeheadline and \makefootline, which use the
- % values in \headline and \footline.
- %
- % Common context changes for both heading and footing.
- % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
- % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
- \def\commonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\txipagewidth \texinfochars}
- %
- \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
- \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
- \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
- \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commonheadfootline \makefootline}%
- %
- {%
- % Set context for writing to auxiliary files like index files.
- % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
- % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
- % before the \shipout runs.
- %
- \atdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
- \turnoffactive
- \shipout\vbox{%
- % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
- \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
- %
- \unvbox\headlinebox
- \pagebody{#1}%
- \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
- % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
- % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
- % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
- \vskip 24pt
- \unvbox\footlinebox
- \fi
- %
- }%
- }%
- \global\topmarksavedfalse
- \advancepageno
- \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
-}
-
-\newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
-
-% Main part of page, including any footnotes
-\def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\txipageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
-{\catcode`\@ =11
-\gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
-% marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
-\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
- \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
-\dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
-\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
-\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
-}
-
-% Check if we are on the first page of a chapter. Used for printing headings.
-\newif\ifchapterpage
-\def\checkchapterpage{%
- % Get the chapter that was current at the end of the last page
- \ifcase1\the\savedtopmark\fi
- \let\prevchaptername\thischaptername
- %
- \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
- \let\curchaptername\thischaptername
- %
- \ifx\curchaptername\prevchaptername
- \chapterpagefalse
- \else
- \chapterpagetrue
- \fi
-}
-
-% Argument parsing
-
-% Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
-% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
-% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
-% For example, \def\foo{\parsearg\fooxxx}.
-%
-\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
-\def\parseargusing#1#2{%
- \def\argtorun{#2}%
- \begingroup
- \obeylines
- \spaceisspace
- #1%
- \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
-}
-
-{\obeylines %
- \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
- \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
- \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
- }%
-}
-
-% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. Pass the result on to
-% \argcheckspaces.
-\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
-\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
-
-% Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
-%
-% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
-% @end itemize @c foo
-% This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
-% by \finishparsearg.
-%
-\def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
-\def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
-\def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
- \def\temp{#3}%
- \ifx\temp\empty
- % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
- \let\temp\finishparsearg
- \else
- \let\temp\argcheckspaces
- \fi
- % Put the space token in:
- \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
-}
-
-% If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
-% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
-% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
-% just before passing the control to \argtorun.
-% (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
-% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
-% that a pair of braces would be stripped.
-%
-% But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
-%
-\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
-
-
-% \parseargdef - define a command taking an argument on the line
-%
-% \parseargdef\foo{...}
-% is roughly equivalent to
-% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
-% \def\Xfoo#1{...}
-\def\parseargdef#1{%
- \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
-}
-\def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
- \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
- \def#1##1%
-}
-
-% Several utility definitions with active space:
-{
- \obeyspaces
- \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
-
- % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
- % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
- % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
- % should produce a line of output anyway.
- %
- \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
-
- % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
- % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
- % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
- \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
-}
-
-
-\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
-
-% Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
-%
-% \envdef\foo{...}
-% \def\Efoo{...}
-%
-% It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
-% actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
-% defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
-% whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
-% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
-%
-% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
-% are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
-% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
-% special case.)
-
-
-% At run-time, environments start with this:
-\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
-% initialize
-\let\thisenv\empty
-
-% ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
-\long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
-\def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
-
-% Check whether we're in the right environment:
-\def\checkenv#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\thisenv\temp
- \else
- \badenverr
- \fi
-}
-
-% Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
-\def\badenverr{%
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
- not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
-}
-\def\inenvironment#1{%
- \ifx#1\empty
- outside of any environment%
- \else
- in environment \expandafter\string#1%
- \fi
-}
-
-% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
-% But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
-%
-\parseargdef\end{%
- \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
- \else
- % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
- \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
- \csname E#1\endcsname
- \endgroup
- \fi
-}
-
-\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
-
-
-% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
-% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
-% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
-% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
-% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
-{\catcode`@ = 11
- % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
- % if the definition is written into an index file.
- \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
- \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
-}
-
-% @: forces normal size whitespace following.
-\def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
-
-% @* forces a line break.
-\def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
-
-% @/ allows a line break.
-\let\/=\allowbreak
-
-% @. is an end-of-sentence period.
-\def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
-
-% @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
-\def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
-
-% @? is an end-of-sentence query.
-\def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
-
-% @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
-%
-\def\onword{on}
-\def\offword{off}
-%
-\parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
- \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
-% beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
-% produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
-\def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
-
-% @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
-% it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
-% to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
-% \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
-% max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
-% therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
-% the text is small, which looks bad.
-%
-% Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
-% cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
-% does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
-% explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
-% threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
-% percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
-%
-\newbox\groupbox
-\def\vfilllimit{0.7}
-%
-\envdef\group{%
- \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
- \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
- \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
- \fi
- \startsavinginserts
- %
- \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
- % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
- % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
- % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
- % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
- % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
- % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
- \comment
-}
-%
-% The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
-% \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
-% \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
-% above. But it's pretty close.
-\def\Egroup{%
- % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
- % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
- \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
- \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
- \egroup % End the \vtop.
- \addgroupbox
- \prevdepth = \dimen1
- \checkinserts
-}
-
-\def\addgroupbox{
- % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
- \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
- % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
- \dimen2 = \txipageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
- % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
- % group, force a page break.
- \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
- \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\txipageheight
- \page
- \fi
- \fi
- \box\groupbox
-}
-
-%
-% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
-% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
-%
-\newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
-group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
-where each line of input produces a line of output.}
-
-% @need space-in-mils
-% forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
-
-\newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
-
-\parseargdef\need{%
- % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
- % paragraph.
- \par
- %
- % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
- \dimen0 = #1\mil
- \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
- \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
- \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
- %
- % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
- % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
- % And a page break here is fine.
- \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
- %
- % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
- % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
- % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
- % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
- % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
- %
- % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
- % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
- % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
- % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
- % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
- % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
- % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
- \penalty9999
- %
- % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
- \kern -#1\mil
- %
- % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
- \nobreak
- \fi
-}
-
-% @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
-
-\let\br = \par
-
-% @page forces the start of a new page.
-%
-\def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
-
-% @exdent text....
-% outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
-
-% This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
-% That's how much \exdent should take out.
-\newskip\exdentamount
-
-% This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
-\parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
-
-% This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
-\parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
- \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
-
-% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
-% paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
-% class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
-%
-\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
-\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
-%
-\def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
- \nobreak
- \kern-\strutdepth
- \vtop to \strutdepth{%
- \baselineskip=\strutdepth
- \vss
- % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
- % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
- \ifx#1l%
- \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
- \else
- \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
- \fi
- \null
- }%
-}}
-\def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
-\def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
-%
-% @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
-% (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
-% else use TEXT for both).
-%
-\def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
-\def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
- \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
- \def\righttext{#2}%
- \else
- \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
- \def\righttext{#1}%
- \fi
- %
- \ifodd\pageno
- \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
- \else
- \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
- \fi
- \temp
-}
-
-% @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
-%
-\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
-\def\includezzz#1{%
- \pushthisfilestack
- \def\thisfile{#1}%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
- \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
- \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
- \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}%
- \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
- %
- % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
- % definitions, etc.
- \expandafter
- }\temp
- \popthisfilestack
-}
-\def\filenamecatcodes{%
- \catcode`\\=\other
- \catcode`~=\other
- \catcode`^=\other
- \catcode`_=\other
- \catcode`|=\other
- \catcode`<=\other
- \catcode`>=\other
- \catcode`+=\other
- \catcode`-=\other
- \catcode`\`=\other
- \catcode`\'=\other
-}
-
-\def\pushthisfilestack{%
- \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
-}
-\def\pushthisfilestackX{%
- \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
-}
-\def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
- \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
-}
-
-\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
-\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
- the stack of filenames is empty.}}
-%
-\def\thisfile{}
-
-% @center line
-% outputs that line, centered.
-%
-\parseargdef\center{%
- \ifhmode
- \let\centersub\centerH
- \else
- \let\centersub\centerV
- \fi
- \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
- \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
-}
-\def\centerH#1{{%
- \hfil\break
- \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
- \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
- \line{#1}%
- \break
-}}
-%
-\newcount\centerpenalty
-\def\centerV#1{%
- % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
- % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
- % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
- % prevent a page break here.
- \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty
- \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
- \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
- \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
-}
-
-% @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
-%
-\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
-
-% @comment ...line which is ignored...
-% @c is the same as @comment
-% @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
-
-
-\def\c{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\active%
-\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
-\cxxx}
-{\catcode`\^^M=\active \gdef\cxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
-%
-\let\comment\c
-
-% @paragraphindent NCHARS
-% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
-% NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
-% We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
-%
-\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
-\def\noneword{none}
-%
-\parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\asisword
- \else
- \ifx\temp\noneword
- \defaultparindent = 0pt
- \else
- \defaultparindent = #1em
- \fi
- \fi
- \parindent = \defaultparindent
-}
-
-% @exampleindent NCHARS
-% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
-% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
-% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
-\parseargdef\exampleindent{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\asisword
- \else
- \ifx\temp\noneword
- \lispnarrowing = 0pt
- \else
- \lispnarrowing = #1em
- \fi
- \fi
-}
-
-% @firstparagraphindent WORD
-% If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
-% after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
-% paragraphs.
-%
-% The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
-% \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
-% We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
-% By default, we suppress indentation.
-%
-\def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
-\def\insertword{insert}
-%
-\parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\noneword
- \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
- \else\ifx\temp\insertword
- \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
-% \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
-%
-% We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
-% paragraph.
-%
-\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
- \gdef\indent {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}%
- \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}%
- \global\everypar = {\kern -\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}%
-}
-%
-\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
- \global\let\indent = \ptexindent
- \global\let\noindent = \ptexnoindent
- \global\everypar = {}%
-}
-
-
-% @refill is a no-op.
-\let\refill=\relax
-
-% @setfilename INFO-FILENAME - ignored
-\let\setfilename=\comment
-
-% @bye.
-\outer\def\bye{\chappager\pagelabels\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
-
-
-\message{pdf,}
-% adobe `portable' document format
-\newcount\tempnum
-\newcount\lnkcount
-\newtoks\filename
-\newcount\filenamelength
-\newcount\pgn
-\newtoks\toksA
-\newtoks\toksB
-\newtoks\toksC
-\newtoks\toksD
-\newbox\boxA
-\newbox\boxB
-\newcount\countA
-\newif\ifpdf
-\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
-
-%
-% For LuaTeX
-%
-
-\newif\iftxiuseunicodedestname
-\txiuseunicodedestnamefalse % For pdfTeX etc.
-
-\ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
-\else
- % Use Unicode destination names
- \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
- % Escape PDF strings with converting UTF-16 from UTF-8
- \begingroup
- \catcode`\%=12
- \directlua{
- function UTF16oct(str)
- tex.sprint(string.char(0x5c) .. '376' .. string.char(0x5c) .. '377')
- for c in string.utfvalues(str) do
- if c < 0x10000 then
- tex.sprint(
- string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
- string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
- math.floor(c / 256), math.floor(c % 256)))
- else
- c = c - 0x10000
- local c_hi = c / 1024 + 0xd800
- local c_lo = c % 1024 + 0xdc00
- tex.sprint(
- string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
- string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
- string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
- string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
- math.floor(c_hi / 256), math.floor(c_hi % 256),
- math.floor(c_lo / 256), math.floor(c_lo % 256)))
- end
- end
- end
- }
- \endgroup
- \def\pdfescapestrutfsixteen#1{\directlua{UTF16oct('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
- % Escape PDF strings without converting
- \begingroup
- \directlua{
- function PDFescstr(str)
- for c in string.bytes(str) do
- if c <= 0x20 or c >= 0x80 or c == 0x28 or c == 0x29 or c == 0x5c then
- tex.sprint(-2,
- string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
- c))
- else
- tex.sprint(-2, string.char(c))
- end
- end
- end
- }
- % The -2 in the arguments here gives all the input to TeX catcode 12
- % (other) or 10 (space), preventing undefined control sequence errors. See
- % https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-texinfo/2019-08/msg00031.html
- %
- \endgroup
- \def\pdfescapestring#1{\directlua{PDFescstr('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
- \ifnum\luatexversion>84
- % For LuaTeX >= 0.85
- \def\pdfdest{\pdfextension dest}
- \let\pdfoutput\outputmode
- \def\pdfliteral{\pdfextension literal}
- \def\pdfcatalog{\pdfextension catalog}
- \def\pdftexversion{\numexpr\pdffeedback version\relax}
- \let\pdfximage\saveimageresource
- \let\pdfrefximage\useimageresource
- \let\pdflastximage\lastsavedimageresourceindex
- \def\pdfendlink{\pdfextension endlink\relax}
- \def\pdfoutline{\pdfextension outline}
- \def\pdfstartlink{\pdfextension startlink}
- \def\pdffontattr{\pdfextension fontattr}
- \def\pdfobj{\pdfextension obj}
- \def\pdflastobj{\numexpr\pdffeedback lastobj\relax}
- \let\pdfpagewidth\pagewidth
- \let\pdfpageheight\pageheight
- \edef\pdfhorigin{\pdfvariable horigin}
- \edef\pdfvorigin{\pdfvariable vorigin}
- \fi
-\fi
-
-% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
-% can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
-\ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
-\else
- \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
- \else
- \ifcase\pdfoutput
- \else
- \pdftrue
- \fi
- \fi
-\fi
-
-\newif\ifpdforxetex
-\pdforxetexfalse
-\ifpdf
- \pdforxetextrue
-\fi
-\ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined\else
- \pdforxetextrue
-\fi
-
-
-% Output page labels information.
-% See PDF reference v.1.7 p.594, section 8.3.1.
-\ifpdf
-\def\pagelabels{%
- \def\title{0 << /P (T-) /S /D >>}%
- \edef\roman{\the\romancount << /S /r >>}%
- \edef\arabic{\the\arabiccount << /S /D >>}%
- %
- % Page label ranges must be increasing. Remove any duplicates.
- % (There is a slight chance of this being wrong if e.g. there is
- % a @contents but no @titlepage, etc.)
- %
- \ifnum\romancount=0 \def\roman{}\fi
- \ifnum\arabiccount=0 \def\title{}%
- \else
- \ifnum\romancount=\arabiccount \def\roman{}\fi
- \fi
- %
- \ifnum\romancount<\arabiccount
- \pdfcatalog{/PageLabels << /Nums [\title \roman \arabic ] >> }\relax
- \else
- \pdfcatalog{/PageLabels << /Nums [\title \arabic \roman ] >> }\relax
- \fi
-}
-\else
- \let\pagelabels\relax
-\fi
-
-\newcount\pagecount \pagecount=0
-\newcount\romancount \romancount=0
-\newcount\arabiccount \arabiccount=0
-\ifpdf
- \let\ptxadvancepageno\advancepageno
- \def\advancepageno{%
- \ptxadvancepageno\global\advance\pagecount by 1
- }
-\fi
-
-
-% PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
-% for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
-% double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
-% interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
-%
-% See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
-% related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
-% to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
-% that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
-% do this reliably, so we use it.
-
-% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
-% which we \xdef.
-\def\txiescapepdf#1{%
- \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
- % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
- % Many times it won't matter.
- \xdef#1{#1}%
- \else
- % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
- % backslashes, and other special chars.
- \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
- \fi
-}
-\def\txiescapepdfutfsixteen#1{%
- \ifx\pdfescapestrutfsixteen\thisisundefined
- % No UTF-16 converting macro available.
- \txiescapepdf{#1}%
- \else
- \xdef#1{\pdfescapestrutfsixteen{#1}}%
- \fi
-}
-
-\newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
-with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
-be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
-output) for that.)}
-
-\ifpdf
- %
- % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
- % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
- % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
- % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
- % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use
- % black by default, though.
- \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
- \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
- %
- % rg sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
- % RG sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
- \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}}
- %
- % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
- % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
- \def\setcolor#1{%
- \xdef\currentcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
- \domark
- \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
- }
- %
- \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
- \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
- \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
- \def\currentcolordefs{}
- %
- \def\makefootline{%
- \baselineskip24pt
- \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
- }
- %
- \def\makeheadline{%
- \vbox to 0pt{%
- \vskip-22.5pt
- \line{%
- \vbox to8.5pt{}%
- % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
- \getcolormarks
- % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
- \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
- }%
- \vss
- }%
- \nointerlineskip
- }
- %
- %
- \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
- %
- % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
- \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
- \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
- %
- % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
- % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
- % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
- % bitmap.
- \let\pdfimgext=\empty
- \begingroup
- \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
- \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
- \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \endgroup
- %
- % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
- % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
- \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
- \immediate\pdfimage
- \else
- \immediate\pdfximage
- \fi
- \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi
- \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi
- \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
- #1.\pdfimgext
- \else
- {#1.\pdfimgext}%
- \fi
- \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
- \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
- \fi}
- %
- \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
- % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
- % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
- \indexnofonts
- \makevalueexpandable
- \turnoffactive
- \iftxiuseunicodedestname
- \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
- % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
- % LuaTeX with byte wise I/O converts Latin-1 characters to Unicode.
- \else
- \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
- % Pass through Unicode characters.
- \else
- % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
- \passthroughcharsfalse
- \fi
- \fi
- \else
- % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
- \passthroughcharsfalse
- \fi
- \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
- \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
- }}
- %
- \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
- \indexnofonts
- \makevalueexpandable
- \turnoffactive
- \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
- % The PDF format can use an extended form of Latin-1 in bookmark
- % strings. See Appendix D of the PDF Reference, Sixth Edition, for
- % the "PDFDocEncoding".
- \passthroughcharstrue
- % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
- % LuaTeX: Convert to Unicode
- % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
- \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
- \else
- \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
- \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
- % For pdfTeX with UTF-8.
- % TODO: the PDF format can use UTF-16 in bookmark strings,
- % but the code for this isn't done yet.
- % Use ASCII approximations.
- \passthroughcharsfalse
- \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
- \else
- % For LuaTeX with UTF-8.
- % Pass through Unicode characters for title texts.
- \passthroughcharstrue
- \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
- \fi
- \else
- % For non-Latin-1 or non-UTF-8 encodings.
- % Use ASCII approximations.
- \passthroughcharsfalse
- \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
- \fi
- \fi
- % LuaTeX: Convert to UTF-16
- % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
- \txiescapepdfutfsixteen\pdfoutlinetext
- }}
- %
- \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
- \setpdfdestname{#1}%
- \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
- }
- %
- % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
- \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
- %
- % by default, use black for everything.
- \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
- \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
- \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
- %
- % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
- % come from Petr Olsak
- \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
- \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
- \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
- \advance\tempnum by 1
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
- %
- % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
- % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
- % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
- % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
- % #4 is the page number
- %
- \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
- % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
- % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
- % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
- % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
- \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
- \setpdfdestname{#3}
- \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
- \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
- \fi
- %
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
- }
- %
- \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
- \begingroup
- % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
- \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
- \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \def\thischapnum{##2}%
- \def\thissecnum{0}%
- \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
- }%
- \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
- \def\thissecnum{##2}%
- \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
- }%
- \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
- \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
- }%
- \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
- }%
- \def\thischapnum{0}%
- \def\thissecnum{0}%
- \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
- %
- % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
- % al. a second time, below.
- \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
- \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
- \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
- \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
- \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
- \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
- \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
- \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
- \readdatafile{toc}%
- %
- % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
- % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
- % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
- %
- % We use the node names as the destinations.
- %
- % Currently we prefix the section name with the section number
- % for chapter and appendix headings only in order to avoid too much
- % horizontal space being required in the PDF viewer.
- \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##2 ##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\unnchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
- %
- % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
- % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
- % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
- % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
- % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
- %
- % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
- % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
- % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
- % we use for the index sort strings.
- %
- \indexnofonts
- \setupdatafile
- % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
- % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
- \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
- \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
- \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
- \input \tocreadfilename
- \endgroup
- }
- {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
- \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
- \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
- \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
- ]
- %
- \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
- \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
- \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
- \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
- \advance\filenamelength by 1
- \fi
- \nextsp}
- \def\getfilename#1{%
- \filenamelength=0
- % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
- % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
- \edef\temp{#1}%
- \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
- }
- \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
- \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
- \else
- \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
- \fi
- % make a live url in pdf output.
- \def\pdfurl#1{%
- \begingroup
- % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
- % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
- % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
- % people have actually reported a problem with.
- %
- \normalturnoffactive
- \def\@{@}%
- \let\/=\empty
- \makevalueexpandable
- % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
- % special-casing \var here?
- \def\var##1{##1}%
- %
- \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
- user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
- \endgroup}
- % \pdfgettoks - Surround page numbers in #1 with @pdflink. #1 may
- % be a simple number, or a list of numbers in the case of an index
- % entry.
- \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
- \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
- \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
- \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
- \def\maketoks{%
- \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
- \ifx\first0\adn0
- \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
- \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
- \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
- \else
- \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
- \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
- \let\next=\maketoks
- \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
- \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
- \fi
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
- \next}
- \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
- {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
- \def\pdflink#1{%
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
- \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
- \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
-\else
- % non-pdf mode
- \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
- \let\pdfurl = \gobble
- \let\endlink = \relax
- \let\setcolor = \gobble
- \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
- \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
-\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
-
-%
-% For XeTeX
-%
-\ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
-\else
- %
- % XeTeX version check
- %
- \ifnum\strcmp{\the\XeTeXversion\XeTeXrevision}{0.99996}>-1
- % TeX Live 2016 contains XeTeX 0.99996 and xdvipdfmx 20160307.
- % It can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special (from TeX Live SVN r40941).
- % For avoiding PDF destination name replacement, we use this special
- % instead of xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
- \special{dvipdfmx:config C 0x0010}
- % XeTeX 0.99995+ comes with xdvipdfmx 20160307+.
- % It can handle Unicode destination names for PDF.
- \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
- \else
- % XeTeX < 0.99996 (TeX Live < 2016) cannot use the
- % `dvipdfmx:config' special.
- % So for avoiding PDF destination name replacement,
- % xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010' is necessary.
- %
- % XeTeX < 0.99995 can not handle Unicode destination names for PDF
- % because xdvipdfmx 20150315 has a UTF-16 conversion issue.
- % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
- \txiuseunicodedestnamefalse
- \fi
- %
- % Color support
- %
- \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
- \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
- %
- \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\special{pdf:scolor [#1]}}
- %
- % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
- % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
- \def\setcolor#1{%
- \xdef\currentcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
- \domark
- \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
- }
- %
- \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
- \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
- \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
- \def\currentcolordefs{}
- %
- \def\makefootline{%
- \baselineskip24pt
- \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
- }
- %
- \def\makeheadline{%
- \vbox to 0pt{%
- \vskip-22.5pt
- \line{%
- \vbox to8.5pt{}%
- % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
- \getcolormarks
- % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
- \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
- }%
- \vss
- }%
- \nointerlineskip
- }
- %
- % PDF outline support
- %
- % Emulate pdfTeX primitive
- \def\pdfdest name#1 xyz{%
- \special{pdf:dest (#1) [@thispage /XYZ @xpos @ypos null]}%
- }
- %
- \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
- % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
- % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
- \indexnofonts
- \makevalueexpandable
- \turnoffactive
- \iftxiuseunicodedestname
- % Pass through Unicode characters.
- \else
- % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
- \passthroughcharsfalse
- \fi
- \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
- \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
- }}
- %
- \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
- \turnoffactive
- % Always use Unicode characters in title texts.
- \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
- % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts to UTF-16.
- % So we do not convert.
- \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
- }}
- %
- \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
- \setpdfdestname{#1}%
- \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
- }
- %
- % by default, use black for everything.
- \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
- \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
- \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
- %
- \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
- \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
- \setpdfdestname{#3}
- \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
- \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
- \fi
- %
- \special{pdf:out [-] #2 << /Title (\pdfoutlinetext) /A
- << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >> }%
- }
- %
- \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
- \begingroup
- %
- % For XeTeX, counts of subentries are not necessary.
- % Therefore, we read toc only once.
- %
- % We use node names as destinations.
- %
- % Currently we prefix the section name with the section number
- % for chapter and appendix headings only in order to avoid too much
- % horizontal space being required in the PDF viewer.
- \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
- \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##2 ##1}{1}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{2}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{3}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{4}{##3}{##4}}%
- %
- \let\appentry\numchapentry%
- \let\appsecentry\numsecentry%
- \let\appsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
- \let\appsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
- \def\unnchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{1}{##3}{##4}}%
- \let\unnsecentry\numsecentry%
- \let\unnsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
- \let\unnsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
- %
- % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts strings to UTF-16.
- % Therefore, the encoding and the language may not be considered.
- %
- \indexnofonts
- \setupdatafile
- % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
- % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
- \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
- \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
- \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
- \input \tocreadfilename
- \endgroup
- }
- {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
- \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
- \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
- \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
- ]
-
- \special{pdf:docview << /PageMode /UseOutlines >> }
- % ``\special{pdf:tounicode ...}'' is not necessary
- % because xdvipdfmx converts strings from UTF-8 to UTF-16 without it.
- % However, due to a UTF-16 conversion issue of xdvipdfmx 20150315,
- % ``\special{pdf:dest ...}'' cannot handle non-ASCII strings.
- % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
-%
- \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
- \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
- \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
- \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
- \advance\filenamelength by 1
- \fi
- \nextsp}
- \def\getfilename#1{%
- \filenamelength=0
- % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
- % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
- \edef\temp{#1}%
- \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
- }
- % make a live url in pdf output.
- \def\pdfurl#1{%
- \begingroup
- % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
- % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
- % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
- % people have actually reported a problem with.
- %
- \normalturnoffactive
- \def\@{@}%
- \let\/=\empty
- \makevalueexpandable
- % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
- % special-casing \var here?
- \def\var##1{##1}%
- %
- \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
- \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
- /Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >> >>}%
- \endgroup}
- \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\special{pdf:eann}}
- \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
- \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
- \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
- \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
- \def\maketoks{%
- \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
- \ifx\first0\adn0
- \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
- \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
- \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
- \else
- \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
- \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
- \let\next=\maketoks
- \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
- \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
- \fi
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
- \next}
- \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
- {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
- \def\pdflink#1{%
- \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
- /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A << /S /GoTo /D (#1) >> >>}%
- \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
- \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
-%
- %
- % @image support
- %
- % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
- \def\doxeteximage#1#2#3{%
- \def\xeteximagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \def\xeteximageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
- %
- % XeTeX (and the PDF format) supports .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
- % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
- % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
- % bitmap.
- \let\xeteximgext=\empty
- \begingroup
- \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
- \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for XeTeX}%
- \else \gdef\xeteximgext{JPG}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpeg}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpg}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\xeteximgext{png}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\xeteximgext{PDF}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\xeteximgext{pdf}%
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \endgroup
- %
- \def\xetexpdfext{pdf}%
- \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
- \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
- \else
- \def\xetexpdfext{PDF}%
- \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
- \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
- \else
- \XeTeXpicfile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
- \fi
- \fi
- \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \xeteximagewidth \fi
- \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \xeteximageheight \fi \relax
- }
-\fi
-
-
-%
-\message{fonts,}
-
-% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
-% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
-% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
-%
-\def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
-\def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
-\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
-%
-% can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
-\def\baselinefactor{1}
-%
-\newdimen\textleading
-\def\setleading#1{%
- \dimen0 = #1\relax
- \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
- \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
- \normalbaselines
- \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
- \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
- depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
- }%
-}
-
-% PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
-%
-% do nothing with this by default.
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
-
-% if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
-% (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
-% older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
-\ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
- \begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
- \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-8 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<23> <26> <0023>
-<28> <3B> <0028>
-<3F> <5B> <003F>
-<5D> <5E> <005D>
-<61> <7A> <0061>
-<7B> <7C> <2013>
-endbfrange
-40 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <00660066>
-<0C> <00660069>
-<0D> <0066006C>
-<0E> <006600660069>
-<0F> <00660066006C>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<21> <0021>
-<22> <201D>
-<27> <2019>
-<3C> <00A1>
-<3D> <003D>
-<3E> <00BF>
-<5C> <201C>
-<5F> <02D9>
-<60> <2018>
-<7D> <02DD>
-<7E> <007E>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
- }\endgroup
- \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
- \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
- }%
-%
-% \cmapOT1IT
- \begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
- \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1IT)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-8 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<25> <26> <0025>
-<28> <3B> <0028>
-<3F> <5B> <003F>
-<5D> <5E> <005D>
-<61> <7A> <0061>
-<7B> <7C> <2013>
-endbfrange
-42 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <00660066>
-<0C> <00660069>
-<0D> <0066006C>
-<0E> <006600660069>
-<0F> <00660066006C>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<21> <0021>
-<22> <201D>
-<23> <0023>
-<24> <00A3>
-<27> <2019>
-<3C> <00A1>
-<3D> <003D>
-<3E> <00BF>
-<5C> <201C>
-<5F> <02D9>
-<60> <2018>
-<7D> <02DD>
-<7E> <007E>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
- }\endgroup
- \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
- \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
- }%
-%
-% \cmapOT1TT
- \begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
- \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1TT)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-5 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<21> <26> <0021>
-<28> <5F> <0028>
-<61> <7E> <0061>
-endbfrange
-32 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <2191>
-<0C> <2193>
-<0D> <0027>
-<0E> <00A1>
-<0F> <00BF>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<20> <2423>
-<27> <2019>
-<60> <2018>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
- }\endgroup
- \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
- \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
- }%
-\fi\fi
-
-
-% Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
-% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
-% encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
-% Example:
-% #1 = \textrm
-% #2 = \rmshape
-% #3 = 10
-% #4 = \mainmagstep
-% #5 = OT1
-%
-\def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
- \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
- \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
-}
-% This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
-\let\cmap\gobble
-%
-% (end of cmaps)
-
-% Use cm as the default font prefix.
-% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
-% before you read in texinfo.tex.
-\ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
-\def\fontprefix{cm}
-\fi
-% Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
-\def\rmshape{r}
-\def\rmbshape{bx} % where the normal face is bold
-\def\bfshape{b}
-\def\bxshape{bx}
-\def\ttshape{tt}
-\def\ttbshape{tt}
-\def\ttslshape{sltt}
-\def\itshape{ti}
-\def\itbshape{bxti}
-\def\slshape{sl}
-\def\slbshape{bxsl}
-\def\sfshape{ss}
-\def\sfbshape{ss}
-\def\scshape{csc}
-\def\scbshape{csc}
-
-% Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.)
-%
-\def\definetextfontsizexi{%
-% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
-\def\textnominalsize{11pt}
-\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\def\textecsize{1095}
-
-% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
-\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
-\let\ttslfont=\defttsl \let\slfont=\defsl \bf}
-
-% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
-\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalli=cmmi9
-\font\smallsy=cmsy9
-\def\smallecsize{0900}
-
-% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
-\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
-\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalleri=cmmi8
-\font\smallersy=cmsy8
-\def\smallerecsize{0800}
-
-% Fonts for math mode superscripts (7pt).
-\def\sevennominalsize{7pt}
-\setfont\sevenrm\rmshape{7}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\seventt\ttshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\sevenbf\bfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
-\setfont\sevenit\itshape{7}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\sevensl\slshape{10}{700}{OT1}
-\setfont\sevensf\sfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
-\setfont\sevensc\scshape{10}{700}{OT1}
-\setfont\seventtsl\ttslshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
-\font\seveni=cmmi7
-\font\sevensy=cmsy7
-\def\sevenecsize{0700}
-
-% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
-\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
-\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
-\def\titleecsize{2074}
-
-% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
-\def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
-\let\chapbf=\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
-\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
-\def\chapecsize{1728}
-
-% Section fonts (14.4pt).
-\def\secnominalsize{14pt}
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\secrmnotbold\rmshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
-\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
-\def\sececsize{1440}
-
-% Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
-\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
-\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
-\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
-\def\ssececsize{1200}
-
-% Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (10pt).
-\def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
-\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\font\reducedi=cmmi10
-\font\reducedsy=cmsy10
-\def\reducedecsize{1000}
-
-\textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM
-\textfonts % reset the current fonts
-\rm
-} % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
-
-
-% Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
-% section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
-% Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
-% future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
-%
-\def\definetextfontsizex{%
-% Text fonts (10pt).
-\def\textnominalsize{10pt}
-\edef\mainmagstep{1000}
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\def\textecsize{1000}
-
-% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
-\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
-\let\slfont=\defsl \let\ttslfont=\defttsl \bf}
-
-% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
-\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalli=cmmi9
-\font\smallsy=cmsy9
-\def\smallecsize{0900}
-
-% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
-\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
-\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalleri=cmmi8
-\font\smallersy=cmsy8
-\def\smallerecsize{0800}
-
-% Fonts for math mode superscripts (7pt).
-\def\sevennominalsize{7pt}
-\setfont\sevenrm\rmshape{7}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\seventt\ttshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\sevenbf\bfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
-\setfont\sevenit\itshape{7}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\sevensl\slshape{10}{700}{OT1}
-\setfont\sevensf\sfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
-\setfont\sevensc\scshape{10}{700}{OT1}
-\setfont\seventtsl\ttslshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
-\font\seveni=cmmi7
-\font\sevensy=cmsy7
-\def\sevenecsize{0700}
-
-% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
-\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
-\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
-\def\titleecsize{2074}
-
-% Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
-\def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\chapbf\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
-\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
-\def\chapecsize{1440}
-
-% Section fonts (12pt).
-\def\secnominalsize{12pt}
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\font\seci=cmmi12
-\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
-\def\sececsize{1200}
-
-% Subsection fonts (10pt).
-\def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\font\sseci=cmmi10
-\font\ssecsy=cmsy10
-\def\ssececsize{1000}
-
-% Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (9pt).
-\def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
-\font\reducedi=cmmi9
-\font\reducedsy=cmsy9
-\def\reducedecsize{0900}
-
-\divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs
-\textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM
-\textfonts % reset the current fonts
-\rm
-} % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
-
-% Fonts for short table of contents.
-\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
-\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
-
-
-% We provide the user-level command
-% @fonttextsize 10
-% (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
-%
-\def\xiword{11}
-\def\xword{10}
-\def\xwordpt{10pt}
-%
-\parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
- \def\textsizearg{#1}%
- %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
- %
- % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
- % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
- %
- \begingroup \globaldefs=1
- \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
- \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
- \else
- \errhelp=\EMsimple
- \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
- \fi\fi
- \endgroup
-}
-
-%
-% Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
-% For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
-% italics, not bold italics.
-%
-\def\setfontstyle#1{%
- \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
- \csname #1font\endcsname % change the current font
-}
-
-\def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
-\def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
-\def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
-\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
-\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}\def\ttstylename{tt}
-
-% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
-% So we set up a \sf.
-\newfam\sffam
-\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
-
-% We don't need math for this font style.
-\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
-
-
-% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
-% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families.
-% We don't bother to reset \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need.
-%
-\def\resetmathfonts{%
- \textfont0=\rmfont \textfont1=\ifont \textfont2=\syfont
- \textfont\itfam=\itfont \textfont\slfam=\slfont \textfont\bffam=\bffont
- \textfont\ttfam=\ttfont \textfont\sffam=\sffont
- %
- % Fonts for superscript. Note that the 7pt fonts are used regardless
- % of the current font size.
- \scriptfont0=\sevenrm \scriptfont1=\seveni \scriptfont2=\sevensy
- \scriptfont\itfam=\sevenit \scriptfont\slfam=\sevensl
- \scriptfont\bffam=\sevenbf \scriptfont\ttfam=\seventt
- \scriptfont\sffam=\sevensf
-}
-
-%
-
-% The font-changing commands (all called \...fonts) redefine the meanings
-% of \STYLEfont, instead of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs
-% to also set the current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm)
-% commands hardwire \STYLEfont to set the current font.
-%
-% The fonts used for \ifont are for "math italics" (\itfont is for italics
-% in regular text). \syfont is also used in math mode only.
-%
-% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
-% and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used
-% in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
-%
-% This all needs generalizing, badly.
-%
-
-\def\assignfonts#1{%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\rmfont\csname #1rm\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\itfont\csname #1it\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\slfont\csname #1sl\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\bffont\csname #1bf\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttfont\csname #1tt\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\smallcaps\csname #1sc\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\sffont \csname #1sf\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\ifont \csname #1i\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\syfont \csname #1sy\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttslfont\csname #1ttsl\endcsname
-}
-
-\newif\ifrmisbold
-
-% Select smaller font size with the current style. Used to change font size
-% in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms. If we are using bold fonts for
-% normal roman text, also use bold fonts for roman text in the smaller size.
-\def\switchtolllsize{%
- \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lllsize}%
- \ifrmisbold
- \let\rmfont\bffont
- \fi
- \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
-}%
-
-\def\switchtolsize{%
- \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lsize}%
- \ifrmisbold
- \let\rmfont\bffont
- \fi
- \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
-}%
-
-\def\definefontsetatsize#1#2#3#4#5{%
-\expandafter\def\csname #1fonts\endcsname{%
- \def\curfontsize{#1}%
- \def\lsize{#2}\def\lllsize{#3}%
- \csname rmisbold#5\endcsname
- \assignfonts{#1}%
- \resetmathfonts
- \setleading{#4}%
-}}
-
-\definefontsetatsize{text} {reduced}{smaller}{\textleading}{false}
-\definefontsetatsize{title} {chap} {subsec} {27pt} {true}
-\definefontsetatsize{chap} {sec} {text} {19pt} {true}
-\definefontsetatsize{sec} {subsec} {reduced}{17pt} {true}
-\definefontsetatsize{ssec} {text} {small} {15pt} {true}
-\definefontsetatsize{reduced}{small} {smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
-\definefontsetatsize{small} {smaller}{smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
-\definefontsetatsize{smaller}{smaller}{smaller}{9.5pt} {false}
-
-\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
-\let\subsecfonts = \ssecfonts
-\let\subsubsecfonts = \ssecfonts
-
-% Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
-\def\angleleft{$\langle$}
-\def\angleright{$\rangle$}
-
-% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
-\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
-
-% About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
-% can fit this many characters:
-% 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
-% If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
-% 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
-% For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
-% the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
-%
-% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
-% 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
-% --karl, 24jan03.
-
-% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
-%
-\definetextfontsizexi
-
-
-\message{markup,}
-
-% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
-% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
-% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
-% this property, we can check that font parameter.
-%
-\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
-
-% Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
-% define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
-% \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
-% style.
-
-\let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
-
-\def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
- \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
- \markupstylesetup
-}
-
-\let\markupstylesetup\empty
-
-\def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
- \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
- \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
- \def#1%
-}
-
-% Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
-\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
- \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
- \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
-}
-
-\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
- \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
- \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
-}
-
-{
-\catcode`\'=\active
-\catcode`\`=\active
-
-\gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
-\gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
-
-\gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
-\gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
-}
-
-\let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
-%
-\let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
-%
-\let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright
-%
-\let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
-%
-\let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
-%
-\let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
-
-% Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
-% (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
-% The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
-% works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
-% lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
-%
-\def\codequoteright{%
- \ifmonospace
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
- '%
- \else \char'15 \fi
- \else \char'15 \fi
- \else
- '%
- \fi
-}
-%
-% and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
-% Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
-% the code environments to do likewise.
-%
-\def\codequoteleft{%
- \ifmonospace
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
- % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
- % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
- \relax`%
- \else \char'22 \fi
- \else \char'22 \fi
- \else
- \relax`%
- \fi
-}
-
-% Commands to set the quote options.
-%
-\parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\onword
- \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
- = t%
- \else\ifx\temp\offword
- \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
- = \relax
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-%
-\parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\onword
- \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
- = t%
- \else\ifx\temp\offword
- \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
- = \relax
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
-\def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
-
-% Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
-\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
-
-% Font commands.
-
-% #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
-% If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
-% and 2) do not add an italic correction.
-\def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
- \ifusingtt
- {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}%
- {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
- \next
-}
-\def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
-\def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
-
-% Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
-% character) is such as not to need one.
-\def\smartitaliccorrection{%
- \ifx\next,%
- \else\ifx\next-%
- \else\ifx\next.%
- \else\ifx\next\.%
- \else\ifx\next\comma%
- \else\ptexslash
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
- \aftersmartic
-}
-
-% Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns.
-\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
-
-% @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
-% ttsl for book titles, do we?
-\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
-
-\def\aftersmartic{}
-\def\var#1{%
- \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic
- \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}%
- \smartslanted{#1}%
-}
-
-\let\i=\smartitalic
-\let\slanted=\smartslanted
-\let\dfn=\smartslanted
-\let\emph=\smartitalic
-
-% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
-\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
-\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
-\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
-
-% @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
-\def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
-\let\strong=\b
-
-% @sansserif, explicit sans.
-\def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
-
-% We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
-% the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
-% group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
-%
-\def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
-\def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
-
-% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
-% Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
-% sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
-%
-\catcode`@=11
- \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
- \sfcode`\.=\@m \sfcode`\?=\@m \sfcode`\!=\@m
- \sfcode`\:=\@m \sfcode`\;=\@m \sfcode`\,=\@m
- \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
- }
- \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
- \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
- \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
- \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
- }
-\catcode`@=\other
-\def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
-
-% @t, explicit typewriter.
-\def\t#1{%
- {\tt \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
- \null
-}
-
-% @samp.
-\def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
-
-% @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
-\let\indicateurl=\samp
-
-% @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
-% size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
-% This is a subroutine for that.
-\def\tclose#1{%
- {%
- % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
- \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
- %
- % Switch to typewriter.
- \tt
- %
- % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
- \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
- %
- % Turn off hyphenation.
- \nohyphenation
- %
- \plainfrenchspacing
- #1%
- }%
- \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
-}
-
-% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
-% (But see \codedashfinish below.)
-% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
-% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
-%
-% Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
-% both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
-% We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
-% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
-{
- \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
- \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
- \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
- %
- \global\def\code{\begingroup
- \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
- % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
- \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
- \ifallowcodebreaks
- \let-\codedash
- \let_\codeunder
- \else
- \let-\normaldash
- \let_\realunder
- \fi
- % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
- % after the hyphen.
- \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash
- %
- \codex
- }
- %
- \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
- \gdef\codedashfinish{%
- \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
- %
- % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
- % (a) the next character is a -, or
- % (b) the preceding character is a -.
- % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
- % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
- \ifx\next\codedash \else
- \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
- \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
- \fi
- % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
- % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}.
- \global\let\codedashprev= \next
- }
-}
-\def\normaldash{-}
-%
-\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
-
-\def\codeunder{%
- % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
- % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
- % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
- % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
- \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
- \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
- \else\normalunderscore \fi
- \discretionary{}{}{}}%
- {\_}%
-}
-
-% An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
-% each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad.
-% @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
-% and _ on and off.
-%
-\newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
-
-\def\keywordtrue{true}
-\def\keywordfalse{false}
-
-\parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
- \def\txiarg{#1}%
- \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
- \allowcodebreakstrue
- \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
- \allowcodebreaksfalse
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
-% so use \code rather than \samp.
-\let\command=\code
-\let\env=\code
-\let\file=\code
-\let\option=\code
-
-% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
-% (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
-% an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
-% addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
-
-% TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
-% arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
-\newif\ifurefurlonlylink
-
-% The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
-% places within the url. (There used to be another version, which
-% didn't support automatic breaking.)
-\def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
-\let\uref=\urefbreak
-%
-\def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish}
-\def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
- \unsepspaces
- \pdfurl{#1}%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
- \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
- \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
- \else
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
- \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
- \ifpdf
- % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
- \ifurefurlonlylink
- % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
- \unhbox0
- \else
- % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
- % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
- \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
- \fi
- \else
- \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
- \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url
- \else
- % For XeTeX
- \ifurefurlonlylink
- % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
- \unhbox0
- \else
- % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
- % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
- \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- \else
- \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
- \fi
- \fi
- \endlink
-\endgroup}
-
-% Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
-\def\urefcatcodes{%
- \catcode`\&=\active \catcode`\.=\active
- \catcode`\#=\active \catcode`\?=\active
- \catcode`\/=\active
-}
-{
- \urefcatcodes
- %
- \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
- \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
- \urefcatcodes
- \let&\urefcodeamp
- \let.\urefcodedot
- \let#\urefcodehash
- \let?\urefcodequest
- \let/\urefcodeslash
- \codex
- }
- %
- % By default, they are just regular characters.
- \global\def&{\normalamp}
- \global\def.{\normaldot}
- \global\def#{\normalhash}
- \global\def?{\normalquest}
- \global\def/{\normalslash}
-}
-
-\def\urefcodeamp{\urefprebreak \&\urefpostbreak}
-\def\urefcodedot{\urefprebreak .\urefpostbreak}
-\def\urefcodehash{\urefprebreak \#\urefpostbreak}
-\def\urefcodequest{\urefprebreak ?\urefpostbreak}
-\def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
-{
- \catcode`\/=\active
- \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
- \urefprebreak \slashChar
- % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
- % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
- \ifx\next/\else \urefpostbreak \fi
- }
-}
-
-% By default we'll break after the special characters, but some people like to
-% break before the special chars, so allow that. Also allow no breaking at
-% all, for manual control.
-%
-\parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
- \def\txiarg{#1}%
- \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
- \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
- \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
- \def\urefprebreak{\urefallowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
- \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
- \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\urefallowbreak}
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
- \fi\fi\fi
-}
-\def\wordafter{after}
-\def\wordbefore{before}
-\def\wordnone{none}
-
-% Allow a ragged right output to aid breaking long URL's. There can
-% be a break at the \allowbreak with no extra glue (if the existing stretch in
-% the line is sufficient), a break at the \penalty100 with extra glue added
-% at the end of the line, or no break at all here.
-% Changing the value of the penalty and/or the amount of stretch affects how
-% preferable one choice is over the other.
-\def\urefallowbreak{%
- \allowbreak
- \hskip 0pt plus 2 em\relax
- \penalty300
- \hskip 0pt plus -2 em\relax
-}
-
-\urefbreakstyle after
-
-% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
-%
-\let\url=\uref
-
-% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
-% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
-%
-%\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
-\ifpdforxetex
- \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
- \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
- \unsepspaces
- \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
- \endlink
- \endgroup}
-\else
- \let\email=\uref
-\fi
-
-% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
-% `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
-% or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
-\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
- \def\txiarg{#1}%
- \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
- \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
- \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
- \fi\fi\fi
-}
-\def\worddistinct{distinct}
-\def\wordexample{example}
-\def\wordcode{code}
-
-% Default is `distinct'.
-\kbdinputstyle distinct
-
-% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
-% then @kbd has no effect.
-\def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}}
-
-\def\xkey{\key}
-\def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
- \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
- \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
- \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
- \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
-}
-
-% definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
-%\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-%\font\keysy=cmsy9
-%\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
-% \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
-% \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
-% \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
-% \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
-% \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
-
-% definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
-% monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
-% if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
-%
-\def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
- \nohyphenation
- \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
- #1}\null}
-
-% @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
-\def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
-
-% @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
-\parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
-\def\click{\arrow}
-
-% Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
-% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
-%
-\def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
-
-% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
-% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
-% all-uppercase.
-%
-\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
-\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
- {\switchtolsize #1}%
- \def\temp{#2}%
- \ifx\temp\empty \else
- \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
- \fi
- \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
-}
-
-% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
-% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
-%
-\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
-\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
- {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
- \def\temp{#2}%
- \ifx\temp\empty \else
- \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
- \fi
- \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
-}
-
-% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
-%
-\def\asis#1{#1}
-
-% @math outputs its argument in math mode.
-%
-% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
-% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
-% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
-% which is what @var uses.
-{
- \catcode`\_ = \active
- \gdef\mathunderscore{%
- \catcode`\_=\active
- \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
- }
-}
-% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
-% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
-% particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
-%
-% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
-\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
-%
-\def\math{%
- \ifmmode\else % only go into math if not in math mode already
- \tex
- \mathunderscore
- \let\\ = \mathbackslash
- \mathactive
- % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
- \let\"=\ddot
- \let\'=\acute
- \let\==\bar
- \let\^=\hat
- \let\`=\grave
- \let\u=\breve
- \let\v=\check
- \let\~=\tilde
- \let\dotaccent=\dot
- % have to provide another name for sup operator
- \let\mathopsup=\sup
- $\expandafter\finishmath\fi
-}
-\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
-
-% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
-% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
-% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
-%
-{
- \catcode`^ = \active
- \catcode`< = \active
- \catcode`> = \active
- \catcode`+ = \active
- \catcode`' = \active
- \gdef\mathactive{%
- \let^ = \ptexhat
- \let< = \ptexless
- \let> = \ptexgtr
- \let+ = \ptexplus
- \let' = \ptexquoteright
- }
-}
-
-% for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript.
-% If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch
-% into text mode, with smaller fonts. This is a different font than the
-% one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not
-% fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices.
-%
-\def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi}
-\def\finishsub#1{$\sb{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
-%
-\def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi}
-\def\finishsup#1{$\ptexsp{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
-
-% @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
-% Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
-% except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
-%
-\def\outfmtnametex{tex}
-%
-\long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish}
-\long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{%
- \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
- \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
-}
-%
-% @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
-% FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
-\long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish}
-\long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{%
- \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
- \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
-}
-%
-% For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
-% setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
-% example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
-% ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
-% *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
-% well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
-% delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
-%
-\long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
-\long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish}
-\def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{%
- \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
- \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
- \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
-}
-
-% @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
-%
-\long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish}
-\long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{%
- \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
- \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
-}
-
-% @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
-%
-\long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish}
-\long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{%
- \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
-}
-
-
-\message{glyphs,}
-% and logos.
-
-% @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
-\def\@{\char64 }
-\let\atchar=\@
-
-% @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
-\def\lbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char123\else\ensuremath\lbrace\fi}}
-\def\rbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char125\else\ensuremath\rbrace\fi}}
-\let\{=\lbracechar
-\let\}=\rbracechar
-
-% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
-\let\comma = ,
-
-% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
-% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
-\let\, = \ptexc
-\let\dotaccent = \ptexdot
-\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
-\let\tieaccent = \ptext
-\let\ubaraccent = \ptexb
-\let\udotaccent = \d
-
-% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
-% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
-\def\questiondown{?`}
-\def\exclamdown{!`}
-\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{a}}}
-\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{o}}}
-
-% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
-\def\imacro{i}
-\def\jmacro{j}
-\def\dotless#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
- \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
- \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
-% period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
-%
-\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
-
-% @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
-% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
-% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
-% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
-% \scriptscriptstyle).
-%
-\def\LaTeX{%
- L\kern-.36em
- {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
- \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{%
- \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
- % for 10pt running text, lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
- % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
- \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$%
- \else
- % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
- \switchtolllsize A%
- \fi
- }%
- \vss
- }}%
- \kern-.15em
- \TeX
-}
-
-% Some math mode symbols. Define \ensuremath to switch into math mode
-% unless we are already there. Expansion tricks may not be needed here,
-% but safer, and can't hurt.
-\def\ensuremath{\ifmmode \expandafter\asis \else\expandafter\ensuredmath \fi}
-\def\ensuredmath#1{$\relax#1$}
-%
-\def\bullet{\ensuremath\ptexbullet}
-\def\geq{\ensuremath\ge}
-\def\leq{\ensuremath\le}
-\def\minus{\ensuremath-}
-
-% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
-% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
-% typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
-% in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
-% whichever is larger.
-%
-\def\dots{%
- \leavevmode
- \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
- \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
- \dimen0 = \wd0
- \else
- \dimen0 = 1.5em
- \fi
- \hbox to \dimen0{%
- \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
- }%
-}
-
-% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
-%
-\def\enddots{%
- \dots
- \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
-}
-
-% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
-%
-% Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
-% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
-%
-\def\point{$\star$}
-\def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
-\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
-\def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
-\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
-\def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
-
-% The @error{} command.
-% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
-%
-\newbox\errorbox
-%
-{\ttfont \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
-\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
-% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
-\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt}
-%
-\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
- \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
- \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
- \vbox{%
- \hrule height\dimen2
- \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
- \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
- \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
- \hrule height\dimen2}
- \hfil}
-%
-\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
-
-% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
-%
-\def\pounds{\ifmonospace{\ecfont\char"BF}\else{\it\$}\fi}
-
-% @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
-% We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
-% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
-% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
-% It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
-%
-% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
-% that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
-% font height.
-%
-% feymr - regular
-% feymo - slanted
-% feybr - bold
-% feybo - bold slanted
-%
-% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
-% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
-% Hmm.
-%
-% Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
-% Hope not.
-%
-%
-\def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
-\def\eurofont{%
- % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
- % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
- % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
- % font installed.
- %
- % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
- % that to the current nominal size.
- %
- % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
- % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
- %
- \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
- %
- \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
- % bold:
- \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
- \else
- % regular:
- \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
- \fi
- \thiseurofont
-}
-
-% Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
-% sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
-% the redefinition.
-%
-% Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
-\def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
-\def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
-\def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
-\def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
-%
-\def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
-\def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
-\def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
-\def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
-\def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
-\def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
-\def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
-\def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
-%
-% This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
-% we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
-% tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
-% dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
-%
-% ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
-% the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
-% the same EC font.
-\def\ogonek#1{{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
- \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
- \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
- \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
- \else
- \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
- \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
- \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
- \fi
- \fi\fi\fi\fi
- }%
-}
-\def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
-\def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
-\def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
-\def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
-%
-% Use the European Computer Modern fonts (cm-super in outline format)
-% for non-CM glyphs. That is ec* for regular text and tc* for the text
-% companion symbols (LaTeX TS1 encoding). Both are part of the ec
-% package and follow the same conventions.
-%
-\def\ecfont{\etcfont{e}}
-\def\tcfont{\etcfont{t}}
-%
-\def\etcfont#1{%
- % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
- % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
- % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
- % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
- \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
- \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
- \ifmonospace
- % typewriter:
- \font\thisecfont = #1ctt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
- \else
- \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
- % bold:
- \font\thisecfont = #1cb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
- \else
- % regular:
- \font\thisecfont = #1c\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
- \fi
- \fi
- \thisecfont
-}
-
-% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
-% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
-% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
-%
-\def\registeredsymbol{%
- $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize R}%
- \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
- }$%
-}
-
-% @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
-%
-\def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
-
-% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
-% Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
-% so we'll define it if necessary.
-%
-\ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
-\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
-\fi
-
-% Quotes.
-\chardef\quoteleft=`\`
-\chardef\quoteright=`\'
-
-% only change font for tt for correct kerning and to avoid using
-% \ecfont unless necessary.
-\def\quotedblleft{%
- \ifmonospace{\ecfont\char"10}\else{\char"5C}\fi
-}
-
-\def\quotedblright{%
- \ifmonospace{\ecfont\char"11}\else{\char`\"}\fi
-}
-
-
-\message{page headings,}
-
-\newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
-\newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
-
-% First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
-\newif\ifseenauthor
-\newif\iffinishedtitlepage
-
-% @setcontentsaftertitlepage used to do an implicit @contents or
-% @shortcontents after @end titlepage, but it is now obsolete.
-\def\setcontentsaftertitlepage{%
- \errmessage{@setcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
- command; move your @contents command if you want the contents
- after the title page.}}%
-\def\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage{%
- \errmessage{@setshortcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
- command; move your @shortcontents and @contents commands if you
- want the contents after the title page.}}%
-
-\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
- \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
- \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
-
-\envdef\titlepage{%
- % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
- \begingroup
- \parindent=0pt \textfonts
- % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
- \vglue\titlepagetopglue
- % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
- \finishedtitlepagetrue
- %
- % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
- % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
- \let\oldpage = \page
- \def\page{%
- \iffinishedtitlepage\else
- \finishtitlepage
- \fi
- \let\page = \oldpage
- \page
- \null
- }%
-}
-
-\def\Etitlepage{%
- \iffinishedtitlepage\else
- \finishtitlepage
- \fi
- % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
- % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
- % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
- % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
- \oldpage
- \endgroup
- %
- % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
- % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
- \HEADINGSon
-}
-
-\def\finishtitlepage{%
- \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
- \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
- \finishedtitlepagetrue
-}
-
-% Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
-% don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used
-% inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. \par should
-% be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
-%
-\def\raggedtitlesettings{%
- \rm
- \hyphenpenalty=10000
- \parindent=0pt
- \tolerance=5000
- \ptexraggedright
-}
-
-% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
-
-\let\subtitlerm=\rmfont
-\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
-
-\parseargdef\title{%
- \checkenv\titlepage
- \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
- % print a rule at the page bottom also.
- \finishedtitlepagefalse
- \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
-}
-
-\parseargdef\subtitle{%
- \checkenv\titlepage
- {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
-}
-
-% @author should come last, but may come many times.
-% It can also be used inside @quotation.
-%
-\parseargdef\author{%
- \def\temp{\quotation}%
- \ifx\thisenv\temp
- \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
- \else
- \checkenv\titlepage
- \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
- {\secfonts\rm \leftline{#1}}%
- \fi
-}
-
-
-% Set up page headings and footings.
-
-\let\thispage=\folio
-
-\newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
-\newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
-\newtoks\evenchapheadline% headline on even pages with a new chapter
-\newtoks\oddchapheadline % headline on odd pages with a new chapter
-\newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
-\newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
-
-% Now make \makeheadline and \makefootline in Plain TeX use those variables
-\headline={{\textfonts\rm
- \ifchapterpage
- \ifodd\pageno\the\oddchapheadline\else\the\evenchapheadline\fi
- \else
- \ifodd\pageno\the\oddheadline\else\the\evenheadline\fi
- \fi}}
-
-\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
- \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
-\let\HEADINGShook=\relax
-
-% Commands to set those variables.
-% For example, this is what @headings on does
-% @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
-% @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
-% @evenfooting @thisfile||
-% @oddfooting ||@thisfile
-
-
-\def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
-\def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
- \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}
- \global\evenchapheadline=\evenheadline}
-
-\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
-\def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
- \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
- \global\oddchapheadline=\oddheadline}
-
-\parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
-
-\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
-\def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
-\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
-
-\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
-\def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
- \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
- %
- % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
- % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
- \global\advance\txipageheight by -12pt
- \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
-}
-
-\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
-
-% @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
-% @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
-%
-% The same set of arguments for:
-%
-% @oddheadingmarks
-% @evenfootingmarks
-% @oddfootingmarks
-% @everyheadingmarks
-% @everyfootingmarks
-
-% These define \getoddheadingmarks, \getevenheadingmarks,
-% \getoddfootingmarks, and \getevenfootingmarks, each to one of
-% \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks.
-%
-\def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
-\def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
-\def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
-\def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
-\parseargdef\everyheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
- \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
-\parseargdef\everyfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
- \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
-% #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
-\def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
- \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
-}
-
-\everyheadingmarks bottom
-\everyfootingmarks bottom
-
-% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
-% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
-% @headings off turns them off.
-% @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
-% @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
-% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
-% @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
-% By default, they are off at the start of a document,
-% and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
-
-\parseargdef\headings{\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
-
-\def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
- \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}\evenchapheadline={\hfil}%
- \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}\oddchapheadline={\hfil}%
-}
-
-\def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
-\HEADINGSoff % it's the default
-
-% When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
-\def\pageone{
- \global\pageno=1
- \global\arabiccount = \pagecount
-}
-
-% For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
-% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
-% title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
-% edge of all pages.
-\def\HEADINGSdouble{%
-\pageone
-\HEADINGSdoublex
-}
-\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-
-% For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
-% page number on top right.
-\def\HEADINGSsingle{%
-\pageone
-\HEADINGSsinglex
-}
-\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
-
-\def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
-\let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
-\def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
-\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\evenchapheadline={\line{\folio\hfil}}
-\global\oddchapheadline={\line{\hfil\folio}}
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
-}
-
-\def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
-\def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
-\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\evenchapheadline={\line{\hfil\folio}}
-\global\oddchapheadline={\line{\hfil\folio}}
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-}
-
-% for @setchapternewpage off
-\def\HEADINGSsinglechapoff{%
-\pageone
-\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\evenchapheadline=\evenheadline
-\global\oddchapheadline=\oddheadline
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-}
-
-% Subroutines used in generating headings
-% This produces Day Month Year style of output.
-% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
-% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
-\ifx\today\thisisundefined
-\def\today{%
- \number\day\space
- \ifcase\month
- \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
- \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
- \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
- \fi
- \space\number\year}
-\fi
-
-% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
-% It generates no output of its own.
-\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
-\def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
-
-
-\message{tables,}
-% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
-
-% default indentation of table text
-\newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
-% default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
-\newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
-% margin between end of table item and start of table text.
-\newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
-
-% used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
-\newdimen\itemmax
-
-% Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
-% these defs.
-% They also define \itemindex
-% to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
-
-\newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
-
-\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
-
-\def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
-\def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
-
-\def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
- \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
- \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
- \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
- \itemindex{#1}%
- \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
- %
- % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
- % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
- % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
- % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
- % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
- \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
- %
- % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
- % but leave it ragged-right.
- \begingroup
- \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
- \advance\hsize by\tableindent
- \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax
- \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
- \endgroup
- %
- % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
- % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
- \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
- %
- % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
- % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
- % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
- % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
- % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
- % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
- %
- \penalty 10001
- \endgroup
- \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
- \else
- % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
- % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
- \noindent
- % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
- % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
- % eventually be printed.
- \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
- \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
- \unhbox0
- \nobreak\kern\dimen0
- \endgroup
- \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
- \fi
-}
-
-\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
-\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
-
-% @table, @ftable, @vtable.
-\envdef\table{%
- \let\itemindex\gobble
- \tablecheck{table}%
-}
-\envdef\ftable{%
- \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
- \tablecheck{ftable}%
-}
-\envdef\vtable{%
- \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
- \tablecheck{vtable}%
-}
-\def\tablecheck#1{%
- \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
- \endgroup
- \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
- that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
- \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
- \else
- \let\next\tablex
- \fi
- \next
-}
-\def\tablex#1{%
- \def\itemindicate{#1}%
- \parsearg\tabley
-}
-\def\tabley#1{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
- \expandafter
- }\temp \endtablez
-}
-\def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
- \aboveenvbreak
- \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
- \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
- \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
- \itemmax=\tableindent
- \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
- \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
- \exdentamount=\tableindent
- \parindent = 0pt
- \parskip = \smallskipamount
- \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
- \let\item = \internalBitem
- \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
-}
-\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
-\let\Eftable\Etable
-\let\Evtable\Etable
-\let\Eitemize\Etable
-\let\Eenumerate\Etable
-
-% This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
-
-\newcount \itemno
-
-\envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
-
-\def\doitemize#1{%
- \aboveenvbreak
- \itemmax=\itemindent
- \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
- \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
- \exdentamount=\itemindent
- \parindent=0pt
- \parskip=\smallskipamount
- \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
- %
- % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
- % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
- % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
- % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
- % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
- \def\itemcontents{#1}%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
- %
- % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
- \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
- %
- \let\item=\itemizeitem
-}
-
-% Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
-%
-\def\itemizeitem{%
- \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
- {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
- {%
- % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
- % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
- % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
- % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
- % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
- % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
- % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
- % that's the theory.
- \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
- \noindent
- \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
- %
- \ifinner\else
- \vadjust{\penalty 1200}% not good to break after first line of item.
- \fi
- % We can be in inner vertical mode in a footnote, although an
- % @itemize looks awful there.
- }%
- \flushcr
-}
-
-% \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
-% TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
-%
-\def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
-
-% Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
-% or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
-% argument is the same as `1'.
-%
-\envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
-\def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
- % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
- \def\thearg{#1}%
- \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
- %
- % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
- % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
- % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
- % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
- % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
- \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
- \ifx\rest\empty
- % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
- % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
- % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
- % not equal to itself.
- % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
- %
- % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
- % continuing to look for a <number>.
- %
- \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
- \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
- \else
- % It's a letter.
- \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
- \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
- \else
- \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
- \fi
- \fi
- \else
- % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
- \numericenumerate
- \fi
-}
-
-% An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
-% given in \thearg.
-%
-\def\numericenumerate{%
- \itemno = \thearg
- \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
-}
-
-% The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
-\def\lowercaseenumerate{%
- \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
- \startenumeration{%
- % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
- \ifnum\itemno=0
- \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
- alphabet}%
- \fi
- \char\lccode\itemno
- }%
-}
-
-% The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
-\def\uppercaseenumerate{%
- \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
- \startenumeration{%
- % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
- \ifnum\itemno=0
- \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
- alphabet}
- \fi
- \char\uccode\itemno
- }%
-}
-
-% Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
-% common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
-% \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
-%
-\def\startenumeration#1{%
- \advance\itemno by -1
- \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
-}
-
-% @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
-% to @enumerate.
-%
-\def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
-\def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
-\def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
-\def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
-
-
-% @multitable macros
-% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
-%
-% @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
-% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
-% can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
-% or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
-
-% Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
-
-% To make preamble:
-%
-% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
-% @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
-% @item ...
-%
-% Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
-% current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
-% columns as desired.
-
-
-% Or use a template:
-% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
-% @item ...
-% using the widest term desired in each column.
-
-% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
-% starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
-% with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
-% ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
-
-% @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
-% if they are.
-
-% Sample multitable:
-
-% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
-% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
-% @item
-% first col stuff
-% @tab
-% second col stuff
-% @tab
-% third col
-% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
-% @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
-%
-% They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
-% @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
-% @end multitable
-
-% Default dimensions may be reset by user.
-% @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
-% @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
-% @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
-% @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
-% to baseline.
-% 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
-%
-\newskip\multitableparskip
-\newskip\multitableparindent
-\newdimen\multitablecolspace
-\newskip\multitablelinespace
-\multitableparskip=0pt
-\multitableparindent=6pt
-\multitablecolspace=12pt
-\multitablelinespace=0pt
-
-% Macros used to set up halign preamble:
-%
-\let\endsetuptable\relax
-\def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
-\let\columnfractions\relax
-\def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
-\newif\ifsetpercent
-
-% #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
-% be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
-%
-\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
- \global\advance\colcount by 1
- \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
- \setuptable
-}
-
-\newcount\colcount
-\def\setuptable#1{%
- \def\firstarg{#1}%
- \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
- \let\go = \relax
- \else
- \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
- \global\setpercenttrue
- \else
- \ifsetpercent
- \let\go\pickupwholefraction
- \else
- \global\advance\colcount by 1
- \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
- % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
- \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
- % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
- % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
- \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
- \else
- \let\go = \setuptable
- \fi%
- \fi
- \go
-}
-
-% multitable-only commands.
-%
-% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. Assignments
-% have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an
-% alignment entry. \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to
-% undo it ourselves.
-\def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
-\def\headitem{%
- \checkenv\multitable
- \crcr
- \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings
- \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
- \the\everytab % for the first item
-}%
-%
-% default for tables with no headings.
-\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
-%
-% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
-% line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
-% we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
-% --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
-\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
-
-% @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
-%
-\newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
-%
-\envdef\multitable{%
- \vskip\parskip
- \startsavinginserts
- %
- % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
- % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
- % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
- % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
- \def\item{\crcr}%
- %
- \tolerance=9500
- \hbadness=9500
- \setmultitablespacing
- \parskip=\multitableparskip
- \parindent=\multitableparindent
- \overfullrule=0pt
- \global\colcount=0
- %
- \everycr = {%
- \noalign{%
- \global\everytab={}% Reset from possible headitem.
- \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
- %
- % Check for saved footnotes, etc.:
- \checkinserts
- %
- % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset:
- \headitemcrhook
- \global\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
- }%
- }%
- %
- \parsearg\domultitable
-}
-\def\domultitable#1{%
- % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
- \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
- %
- % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
- % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
- % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
- % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
- \halign\bgroup &%
- \global\advance\colcount by 1
- \multistrut
- \vtop{%
- % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
- \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
- %
- % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
- % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
- % the first one.
- %
- % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
- % to the width of each template entry.
- %
- % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
- % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
- % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
- % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
- %
- % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
- \rightskip=0pt
- \ifnum\colcount=1
- % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
- \advance\hsize by\leftskip
- \else
- \ifsetpercent \else
- % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
- % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
- \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
- \fi
- % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
- \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
- \fi
- % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
- % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
- % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
- % For example:
- % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
- % @item @code{#}
- % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
- % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
- % marking characters.
- \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
- }\cr
-}
-\def\Emultitable{%
- \crcr
- \egroup % end the \halign
- \global\setpercentfalse
-}
-
-\def\setmultitablespacing{%
- \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
- %
- % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
- % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
- % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
- % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
-\ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
-\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
-\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
-\fi
-% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
-% table. If not, do nothing.
-% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
-\ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
-\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
-\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
- % than skip between lines in the table.
-\fi%
-\ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
-\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
-\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
- % than skip between lines in the table.
-\fi}
-
-
-\message{conditionals,}
-
-% @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
-% @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
-% attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
-% have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
-% attempt to close an environment group.
-%
-\def\makecond#1{%
- \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
- \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
-}
-\makecond{iftex}
-\makecond{ifnotdocbook}
-\makecond{ifnothtml}
-\makecond{ifnotinfo}
-\makecond{ifnotplaintext}
-\makecond{ifnotxml}
-
-% Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
-%
-\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
-\def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
-\def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
-\def\html{\doignore{html}}
-\def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
-\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
-\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
-\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
-\def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
-\def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
-\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
-\def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
-\def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
-
-% Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
-%
-% A count to remember the depth of nesting.
-\newcount\doignorecount
-
-\def\doignore#1{\begingroup
- % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
- \obeylines
- \catcode`\@ = \other
- \catcode`\{ = \other
- \catcode`\} = \other
- %
- % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
- \spaceisspace
- %
- % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
- \doignorecount = 0
- %
- % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
- \dodoignore{#1}%
-}
-
-{ \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
- \obeylines %
- %
- \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
- % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
- %
- % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
- \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
- \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
- %
- % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
- % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
- % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
- \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
- %
- % And now expand that command.
- \doignoretext ^^M%
- }%
-}
-
-\def\doignoreyyy#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
- \let\next\doignoretextzzz
- \else % Found a nested condition, ...
- \advance\doignorecount by 1
- \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
- % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
- \fi
- \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
-}
-
-% We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
-%
-\def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
- \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
- \let\next\enddoignore
- \else % Still inside a nested condition.
- \advance\doignorecount by -1
- \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
- \fi
- \next
-}
-
-% Finish off ignored text.
-{ \obeylines%
- % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
- % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
- % would result in a blank line in the output.
- \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
-}
-
-
-% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
-% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
-%
-% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
-% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
-% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
-% didn't need it.
-% We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
-%
-\parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
-\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \def\temp{#2}%
- \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
- \ifx\temp\empty
- \next{}%
- \else
- \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
- \fi
- }%
-}
-% Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
-\def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
-
-% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
-%
-\parseargdef\clear{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
- }%
-}
-
-% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
-\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
-\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
-{
- \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
- %
- \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
- \let\value = \expandablevalue
- % We don't want these characters active, ...
- \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
- % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
- % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
- % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
- \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
- }
-}
-
-\def\expandablevalue#1{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
- {[No value for ``#1'']}%
- \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
- \else
- \csname SET#1\endcsname
- \fi
-}
-
-% Like \expandablevalue, but completely expandable (the \message in the
-% definition above operates at the execution level of TeX). Used when
-% writing to auxiliary files, due to the expansion that \write does.
-% If flag is undefined, pass through an unexpanded @value command: maybe it
-% will be set by the time it is read back in.
-%
-% NB flag names containing - or _ may not work here.
-\def\dummyvalue#1{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
- \string\value{#1}%
- \else
- \csname SET#1\endcsname
- \fi
-}
-
-% Used for @value's in index entries to form the sort key: expand the @value
-% if possible, otherwise sort late.
-\def\indexnofontsvalue#1{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
- ZZZZZZZ%
- \else
- \csname SET#1\endcsname
- \fi
-}
-
-% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
-% with @set.
-%
-% To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
-% \makecond and then redefine.
-%
-\makecond{ifset}
-\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
-\def\doifset#1#2{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \let\next=\empty
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
- #1% If not set, redefine \next.
- \fi
- \expandafter
- }\next
-}
-\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
-
-% @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
-% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
-%
-% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
-% above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
-% then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
-%
-\makecond{ifclear}
-\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
-\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
-
-% @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
-% without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the
-% TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
-% defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
-%
-\makecond{ifcommanddefined}
-\def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
-%
-\def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \let\next=\empty
- \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
- #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
- \fi
- \expandafter
- }\next
-}
-\def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}}
-
-% @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
-\makecond{ifcommandnotdefined}
-\def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
- \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
-\def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}}
-
-% Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
-% test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
-\set txicommandconditionals
-
-% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
-% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
-\let\dircategory=\comment
-
-% @defininfoenclose.
-\let\definfoenclose=\comment
-
-
-\message{indexing,}
-% Index generation facilities
-
-% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
-% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
-\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
-
-% \newindex {foo} defines an index named IX.
-% It automatically defines \IXindex such that
-% \IXindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index IX.
-% It also defines \IXindfile to be the number of the output channel for
-% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is IX.
-% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
-% for the sake of vms.
-%
-\def\newindex#1{%
- \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
- \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
-}
-
-% @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
-%
-\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
-
-% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
-%
-\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
-%
-\def\newcodeindex#1{%
- \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
- \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
-}
-
-% The default indices:
-\newindex{cp}% concepts,
-\newcodeindex{fn}% functions,
-\newcodeindex{vr}% variables,
-\newcodeindex{tp}% types,
-\newcodeindex{ky}% keys
-\newcodeindex{pg}% and programs.
-
-
-% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
-% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
-%
-% @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
-% inside @code.
-%
-\def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
-\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
-
-% #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
-% #3 the target index (bar).
-\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
- \requireopenindexfile{#3}%
- % redefine \fooindfile:
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
- % redefine \fooindex:
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
-}
-
-% Define \doindex, the driver for all index macros.
-% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
-% and it is the two-letter name of the index.
-
-\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\doindexxxx}
-\def\doindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
-
-% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
-\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\docodeindexxxx}
-\def\docodeindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
-
-
-% Used for the aux, toc and index files to prevent expansion of Texinfo
-% commands.
-%
-\def\atdummies{%
- \definedummyletter\@%
- \definedummyletter\ %
- \definedummyletter\{%
- \definedummyletter\}%
- \definedummyletter\&%
- %
- % Do the redefinitions.
- \definedummies
- \otherbackslash
-}
-
-% \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
-% preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
-% not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
-% control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
-% from whatever follows.
-%
-% These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
-% those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
-% that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
-%
-% For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
-% space.
-%
-\def\definedummyword #1{\def#1{\string#1\space}}%
-\def\definedummyletter#1{\def#1{\string#1}}%
-\let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
-
-% Called from \atdummies to prevent the expansion of commands.
-%
-\def\definedummies{%
- %
- \let\commondummyword\definedummyword
- \let\commondummyletter\definedummyletter
- \let\commondummyaccent\definedummyaccent
- \commondummiesnofonts
- %
- \definedummyletter\_%
- \definedummyletter\-%
- %
- % Non-English letters.
- \definedummyword\AA
- \definedummyword\AE
- \definedummyword\DH
- \definedummyword\L
- \definedummyword\O
- \definedummyword\OE
- \definedummyword\TH
- \definedummyword\aa
- \definedummyword\ae
- \definedummyword\dh
- \definedummyword\exclamdown
- \definedummyword\l
- \definedummyword\o
- \definedummyword\oe
- \definedummyword\ordf
- \definedummyword\ordm
- \definedummyword\questiondown
- \definedummyword\ss
- \definedummyword\th
- %
- % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
- \definedummyword\bf
- \definedummyword\gtr
- \definedummyword\hat
- \definedummyword\less
- \definedummyword\sf
- \definedummyword\sl
- \definedummyword\tclose
- \definedummyword\tt
- %
- \definedummyword\LaTeX
- \definedummyword\TeX
- %
- % Assorted special characters.
- \definedummyword\ampchar
- \definedummyword\atchar
- \definedummyword\arrow
- \definedummyword\backslashchar
- \definedummyword\bullet
- \definedummyword\comma
- \definedummyword\copyright
- \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
- \definedummyword\dots
- \definedummyword\enddots
- \definedummyword\entrybreak
- \definedummyword\equiv
- \definedummyword\error
- \definedummyword\euro
- \definedummyword\expansion
- \definedummyword\geq
- \definedummyword\guillemetleft
- \definedummyword\guillemetright
- \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
- \definedummyword\guilsinglright
- \definedummyword\lbracechar
- \definedummyword\leq
- \definedummyword\mathopsup
- \definedummyword\minus
- \definedummyword\ogonek
- \definedummyword\pounds
- \definedummyword\point
- \definedummyword\print
- \definedummyword\quotedblbase
- \definedummyword\quotedblleft
- \definedummyword\quotedblright
- \definedummyword\quoteleft
- \definedummyword\quoteright
- \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
- \definedummyword\rbracechar
- \definedummyword\result
- \definedummyword\sub
- \definedummyword\sup
- \definedummyword\textdegree
- %
- \definedummyword\subentry
- %
- % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
- \macrolist
- \let\value\dummyvalue
- %
- \normalturnoffactive
-}
-
-% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \definedummies and \indexnofonts.
-% Define \commondummyletter, \commondummyaccent and \commondummyword before
-% using. Used for accents, font commands, and various control letters.
-%
-\def\commondummiesnofonts{%
- % Control letters and accents.
- \commondummyletter\!%
- \commondummyaccent\"%
- \commondummyaccent\'%
- \commondummyletter\*%
- \commondummyaccent\,%
- \commondummyletter\.%
- \commondummyletter\/%
- \commondummyletter\:%
- \commondummyaccent\=%
- \commondummyletter\?%
- \commondummyaccent\^%
- \commondummyaccent\`%
- \commondummyaccent\~%
- \commondummyword\u
- \commondummyword\v
- \commondummyword\H
- \commondummyword\dotaccent
- \commondummyword\ogonek
- \commondummyword\ringaccent
- \commondummyword\tieaccent
- \commondummyword\ubaraccent
- \commondummyword\udotaccent
- \commondummyword\dotless
- %
- % Texinfo font commands.
- \commondummyword\b
- \commondummyword\i
- \commondummyword\r
- \commondummyword\sansserif
- \commondummyword\sc
- \commondummyword\slanted
- \commondummyword\t
- %
- % Commands that take arguments.
- \commondummyword\abbr
- \commondummyword\acronym
- \commondummyword\anchor
- \commondummyword\cite
- \commondummyword\code
- \commondummyword\command
- \commondummyword\dfn
- \commondummyword\dmn
- \commondummyword\email
- \commondummyword\emph
- \commondummyword\env
- \commondummyword\file
- \commondummyword\image
- \commondummyword\indicateurl
- \commondummyword\inforef
- \commondummyword\kbd
- \commondummyword\key
- \commondummyword\math
- \commondummyword\option
- \commondummyword\pxref
- \commondummyword\ref
- \commondummyword\samp
- \commondummyword\strong
- \commondummyword\tie
- \commondummyword\U
- \commondummyword\uref
- \commondummyword\url
- \commondummyword\var
- \commondummyword\verb
- \commondummyword\w
- \commondummyword\xref
-}
-
-\let\indexlbrace\relax
-\let\indexrbrace\relax
-\let\indexatchar\relax
-\let\indexbackslash\relax
-
-{\catcode`\@=0
-\catcode`\\=13
- @gdef@backslashdisappear{@def\{}}
-}
-
-{
-\catcode`\<=13
-\catcode`\-=13
-\catcode`\`=13
- \gdef\indexnonalnumdisappear{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax\else
- % @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us ignore left quotes in the sort term.
- % (Introduced for FSFS 2nd ed.)
- \let`=\empty
- \fi
- %
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexbackslashignore\endcsname\relax\else
- \backslashdisappear
- \fi
- %
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexhyphenignore\endcsname\relax\else
- \def-{}%
- \fi
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlessthanignore\endcsname\relax\else
- \def<{}%
- \fi
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexatsignignore\endcsname\relax\else
- \def\@{}%
- \fi
- }
-
- \gdef\indexnonalnumreappear{%
- \let-\normaldash
- \let<\normalless
- }
-}
-
-
-% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
-% by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
-% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
-% would be for a given command (usually its argument).
-%
-\def\indexnofonts{%
- % Accent commands should become @asis.
- \def\commondummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
- % We can just ignore other control letters.
- \def\commondummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
- % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
- \let\commondummyword\commondummyaccent
- \commondummiesnofonts
- %
- % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
- % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
- % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
- %\let\tt=\asis
- %
- \def\ { }%
- \def\@{@}%
- \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
- \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
- %
- \uccode`\1=`\{ \uppercase{\def\{{1}}%
- \uccode`\1=`\} \uppercase{\def\}{1}}%
- \let\lbracechar\{%
- \let\rbracechar\}%
- %
- %
- \let\do\indexnofontsdef
- %
- % Non-English letters.
- \do\AA{AA}%
- \do\AE{AE}%
- \do\DH{DZZ}%
- \do\L{L}%
- \do\OE{OE}%
- \do\O{O}%
- \do\TH{TH}%
- \do\aa{aa}%
- \do\ae{ae}%
- \do\dh{dzz}%
- \do\exclamdown{!}%
- \do\l{l}%
- \do\oe{oe}%
- \do\ordf{a}%
- \do\ordm{o}%
- \do\o{o}%
- \do\questiondown{?}%
- \do\ss{ss}%
- \do\th{th}%
- %
- \do\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
- \do\TeX{TeX}%
- %
- % Assorted special characters.
- \do\atchar{@}%
- \do\arrow{->}%
- \do\bullet{bullet}%
- \do\comma{,}%
- \do\copyright{copyright}%
- \do\dots{...}%
- \do\enddots{...}%
- \do\equiv{==}%
- \do\error{error}%
- \do\euro{euro}%
- \do\expansion{==>}%
- \do\geq{>=}%
- \do\guillemetleft{<<}%
- \do\guillemetright{>>}%
- \do\guilsinglleft{<}%
- \do\guilsinglright{>}%
- \do\leq{<=}%
- \do\lbracechar{\{}%
- \do\minus{-}%
- \do\point{.}%
- \do\pounds{pounds}%
- \do\print{-|}%
- \do\quotedblbase{"}%
- \do\quotedblleft{"}%
- \do\quotedblright{"}%
- \do\quoteleft{`}%
- \do\quoteright{'}%
- \do\quotesinglbase{,}%
- \do\rbracechar{\}}%
- \do\registeredsymbol{R}%
- \do\result{=>}%
- \do\textdegree{o}%
- %
- % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
- % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
- % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
- % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
- % that starts with \.
- %
- % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
- % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
- % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
- %
- \macrolist
- \let\value\indexnofontsvalue
-}
-
-% Give the control sequence a definition that removes the {} that follows
-% its use, e.g. @AA{} -> AA
-\def\indexnofontsdef#1#2{\def#1##1{#2}}%
-
-
-
-
-% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
-\def\doind#1#2{%
- \iflinks
- {%
- %
- \requireopenindexfile{#1}%
- \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
- %
- \def\indextext{#2}%
- \safewhatsit\doindwrite
- }%
- \fi
-}
-
-% Check if an index file has been opened, and if not, open it.
-\def\requireopenindexfile#1{%
-\ifnum\csname #1indfile\endcsname=0
- \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
- \edef\suffix{#1}%
- % A .fls suffix would conflict with the file extension for the output
- % of -recorder, so use .f1s instead.
- \ifx\suffix\indexisfl\def\suffix{f1}\fi
- % Open the file
- \immediate\openout\csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.\suffix
- % Using \immediate above here prevents an object entering into the current
- % box, which could confound checks such as those in \safewhatsit for
- % preceding skips.
- \typeout{Writing index file \jobname.\suffix}%
-\fi}
-\def\indexisfl{fl}
-
-% Definition for writing index entry sort key.
-{
-\catcode`\-=13
-\gdef\indexwritesortas{%
- \begingroup
- \indexnonalnumreappear
- \indexwritesortasxxx}
-\gdef\indexwritesortasxxx#1{%
- \xdef\indexsortkey{#1}\endgroup}
-}
-
-\def\indexwriteseealso#1{
- \gdef\pagenumbertext{\string\seealso{#1}}%
-}
-\def\indexwriteseeentry#1{
- \gdef\pagenumbertext{\string\seeentry{#1}}%
-}
-
-% The default definitions
-\def\sortas#1{}%
-\def\seealso#1{\i{\putwordSeeAlso}\ #1}% for sorted index file only
-\def\putwordSeeAlso{See also}
-\def\seeentry#1{\i{\putwordSee}\ #1}% for sorted index file only
-
-
-% Given index entry text like "aaa @subentry bbb @sortas{ZZZ}":
-% * Set \bracedtext to "{aaa}{bbb}"
-% * Set \fullindexsortkey to "aaa @subentry ZZZ"
-% * If @seealso occurs, set \pagenumbertext
-%
-\def\splitindexentry#1{%
- \gdef\fullindexsortkey{}%
- \xdef\bracedtext{}%
- \def\sep{}%
- \def\seealso##1{}%
- \def\seeentry##1{}%
- \expandafter\doindexsegment#1\subentry\finish\subentry
-}
-
-% append the results from the next segment
-\def\doindexsegment#1\subentry{%
- \def\segment{#1}%
- \ifx\segment\isfinish
- \else
- %
- % Fully expand the segment, throwing away any @sortas directives, and
- % trim spaces.
- \edef\trimmed{\segment}%
- \edef\trimmed{\expandafter\eatspaces\expandafter{\trimmed}}%
- %
- \xdef\bracedtext{\bracedtext{\trimmed}}%
- %
- % Get the string to sort by. Process the segment with all
- % font commands turned off.
- \bgroup
- \let\sortas\indexwritesortas
- \let\seealso\indexwriteseealso
- \let\seeentry\indexwriteseeentry
- \indexnofonts
- % The braces around the commands are recognized by texindex.
- \def\lbracechar{{\string\indexlbrace}}%
- \def\rbracechar{{\string\indexrbrace}}%
- \let\{=\lbracechar
- \let\}=\rbracechar
- \def\@{{\string\indexatchar}}%
- \def\atchar##1{\@}%
- \def\backslashchar{{\string\indexbackslash}}%
- \uccode`\~=`\\ \uppercase{\let~\backslashchar}%
- %
- \let\indexsortkey\empty
- \global\let\pagenumbertext\empty
- % Execute the segment and throw away the typeset output. This executes
- % any @sortas or @seealso commands in this segment.
- \setbox\dummybox = \hbox{\segment}%
- \ifx\indexsortkey\empty{%
- \indexnonalnumdisappear
- \xdef\trimmed{\segment}%
- \xdef\trimmed{\expandafter\eatspaces\expandafter{\trimmed}}%
- \xdef\indexsortkey{\trimmed}%
- \ifx\indexsortkey\empty\xdef\indexsortkey{ }\fi
- }\fi
- %
- % Append to \fullindexsortkey.
- \edef\tmp{\gdef\noexpand\fullindexsortkey{%
- \fullindexsortkey\sep\indexsortkey}}%
- \tmp
- \egroup
- \def\sep{\subentry}%
- %
- \expandafter\doindexsegment
- \fi
-}
-\def\isfinish{\finish}%
-\newbox\dummybox % used above
-
-\let\subentry\relax
-
-% Use \ instead of @ in index files. To support old texi2dvi and texindex.
-% This works without changing the escape character used in the toc or aux
-% files because the index entries are fully expanded here, and \string uses
-% the current value of \escapechar.
-\def\escapeisbackslash{\escapechar=`\\}
-
-% Use \ in index files by default. texi2dvi didn't support @ as the escape
-% character (as it checked for "\entry" in the files, and not "@entry"). When
-% the new version of texi2dvi has had a chance to become more prevalent, then
-% the escape character can change back to @ again. This should be an easy
-% change to make now because both @ and \ are only used as escape characters in
-% index files, never standing for themselves.
-%
-\set txiindexescapeisbackslash
-
-% Write the entry in \indextext to the index file.
-%
-\def\doindwrite{%
- \maybemarginindex
- %
- \atdummies
- %
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexescapeisbackslash\endcsname\relax\else
- \escapeisbackslash
- \fi
- %
- % For texindex which always views { and } as separators.
- \def\{{\lbracechar{}}%
- \def\}{\rbracechar{}}%
- \uccode`\~=`\\ \uppercase{\def~{\backslashchar{}}}%
- %
- % Split the entry into primary entry and any subentries, and get the index
- % sort key.
- \splitindexentry\indextext
- %
- % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
- % the original text, including any font commands. We write
- % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
- % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
- % sorted result.
- %
- \edef\temp{%
- \write\writeto{%
- \string\entry{\fullindexsortkey}%
- {\ifx\pagenumbertext\empty\noexpand\folio\else\pagenumbertext\fi}%
- \bracedtext}%
- }%
- \temp
-}
-
-% Put the index entry in the margin if desired (undocumented).
-\def\maybemarginindex{%
- \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
- \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \relax\indextext}}%
- \fi
-}
-\let\SETmarginindex=\relax
-
-
-% Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
-%
-% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
-% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
-% the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
-% \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
-% sequences like this:
-% @end defun
-% @tindex whatever
-% @defun ...
-% will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
-% start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
-% the previous defun.
-%
-% But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
-% don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
-%
-% Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
-%
-% But wait, there is a catch there:
-% We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
-% sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
-% of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
-% representation of the skip.
-%
-% The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
-% the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
-%
-\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
-%
-\newskip\whatsitskip
-\newcount\whatsitpenalty
-%
-% ..., ready, GO:
-%
-\def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
- #1%
- \else
- % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
- \whatsitskip = \lastskip
- \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
- \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
- %
- % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
- % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
- % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
- % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
- % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
- \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
- \else
- \vskip-\whatsitskip
- \fi
- %
- #1%
- %
- \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
- % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
- % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
- % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
- % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
- % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
- % @deffn deffn-whatever
- % @vindex index-whatever
- % Description.
- % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
- % and the "Description." paragraph.
- \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
- \else
- % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
- % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
- % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
- \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
- \fi
-\fi}
-
-% The index entry written in the file actually looks like
-% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
-% or
-% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
-% The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
-% containing these kinds of lines:
-% \initial {c}
-% before the first topic whose initial is c
-% \entry {topic}{pagelist}
-% for a topic that is used without subtopics
-% \primary {topic}
-% \entry {topic}{}
-% for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
-% \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
-% for each subtopic.
-% \secondary {subtopic}{}
-% for a subtopic with sub-subtopics
-% \tertiary {subtopic}{subsubtopic}{pagelist}
-% for each sub-subtopic.
-
-% Define the user-accessible indexing commands
-% @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
-
-\def\findex {\fnindex}
-\def\kindex {\kyindex}
-\def\cindex {\cpindex}
-\def\vindex {\vrindex}
-\def\tindex {\tpindex}
-\def\pindex {\pgindex}
-
-% Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
-
-% @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
-% It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
-%
-\parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
- \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
- %
- \smallfonts \rm
- \tolerance = 9500
- \plainfrenchspacing
- \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
- %
- % See comment in \requireopenindexfile.
- \def\indexname{#1}\ifx\indexname\indexisfl\def\indexname{f1}\fi
- %
- % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
- \openin 1 \jobname.\indexname s
- \ifeof 1
- % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
- % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
- % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
- % there is some text.
- \putwordIndexNonexistent
- \typeout{No file \jobname.\indexname s.}%
- \else
- % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
- % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
- % it can discover if there is anything in it.
- \read 1 to \thisline
- \ifeof 1
- \putwordIndexIsEmpty
- \else
- \expandafter\printindexzz\thisline\relax\relax\finish%
- \fi
- \fi
- \closein 1
-\endgroup}
-
-% If the index file starts with a backslash, forgo reading the index
-% file altogether. If somebody upgrades texinfo.tex they may still have
-% old index files using \ as the escape character. Reading this would
-% at best lead to typesetting garbage, at worst a TeX syntax error.
-\def\printindexzz#1#2\finish{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexescapeisbackslash\endcsname\relax
- \uccode`\~=`\\ \uppercase{\if\noexpand~}\noexpand#1
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiskipindexfileswithbackslash\endcsname\relax
-\errmessage{%
-ERROR: A sorted index file in an obsolete format was skipped.
-To fix this problem, please upgrade your version of 'texi2dvi'
-or 'texi2pdf' to that at <https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo>.
-If you are using an old version of 'texindex' (part of the Texinfo
-distribution), you may also need to upgrade to a newer version (at least 6.0).
-You may be able to typeset the index if you run
-'texindex \jobname.\indexname' yourself.
-You could also try setting the 'txiindexescapeisbackslash' flag by
-running a command like
-'texi2dvi -t "@set txiindexescapeisbackslash" \jobname.texi'. If you do
-this, Texinfo will try to use index files in the old format.
-If you continue to have problems, deleting the index files and starting again
-might help (with 'rm \jobname.?? \jobname.??s')%
-}%
- \else
- (Skipped sorted index file in obsolete format)
- \fi
- \else
- \begindoublecolumns
- \input \jobname.\indexname s
- \enddoublecolumns
- \fi
- \else
- \begindoublecolumns
- \catcode`\\=0\relax
- \catcode`\@=12\relax
- \input \jobname.\indexname s
- \enddoublecolumns
- \fi
-}
-
-% These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
-% Change them to control the appearance of the index.
-
-{\catcode`\/=13 \catcode`\-=13 \catcode`\^=13 \catcode`\~=13 \catcode`\_=13
-\catcode`\|=13 \catcode`\<=13 \catcode`\>=13 \catcode`\+=13 \catcode`\"=13
-\catcode`\$=3
-\gdef\initialglyphs{%
- % special control sequences used in the index sort key
- \let\indexlbrace\{%
- \let\indexrbrace\}%
- \let\indexatchar\@%
- \def\indexbackslash{\math{\backslash}}%
- %
- % Some changes for non-alphabetic characters. Using the glyphs from the
- % math fonts looks more consistent than the typewriter font used elsewhere
- % for these characters.
- \uccode`\~=`\\ \uppercase{\def~{\math{\backslash}}}
- %
- % In case @\ is used for backslash
- \uppercase{\let\\=~}
- % Can't get bold backslash so don't use bold forward slash
- \catcode`\/=13
- \def/{{\secrmnotbold \normalslash}}%
- \def-{{\normaldash\normaldash}}% en dash `--'
- \def^{{\chapbf \normalcaret}}%
- \def~{{\chapbf \normaltilde}}%
- \def\_{%
- \leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }%
- \def|{$\vert$}%
- \def<{$\less$}%
- \def>{$\gtr$}%
- \def+{$\normalplus$}%
-}}
-
-\def\initial{%
- \bgroup
- \initialglyphs
- \initialx
-}
-
-\def\initialx#1{%
- % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
- \removelastskip
- %
- % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
- % The glue before the bonus allows a little bit of space at the
- % bottom of a column to reduce an increase in inter-line spacing.
- \nobreak
- \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
- \penalty -300
- \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
- %
- % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
- % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
- % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
- % we need before each entry, but it's better.
- %
- % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
- \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus 1\baselineskip
- \leftline{\secfonts \kern-0.05em \secbf #1}%
- % \secfonts is inside the argument of \leftline so that the change of
- % \baselineskip will not affect any glue inserted before the vbox that
- % \leftline creates.
- % Do our best not to break after the initial.
- \nobreak
- \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
- \egroup % \initialglyphs
-}
-
-\newdimen\entryrightmargin
-\entryrightmargin=0pt
-
-% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
-% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
-% and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
-%
-\def\entry{%
- \begingroup
- %
- % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
- % affect previous text.
- \par
- %
- % No extra space above this paragraph.
- \parskip = 0in
- %
- % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
- % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
- % titles, for instance.
- \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
- \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% An undocumented command
- %
- % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
- \afterassignment\doentry
- \let\temp =
-}
-\def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
-\def\doentry{%
- % Save the text of the entry
- \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup
- \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
- \noindent
- \aftergroup\finishentry
- % And now comes the text of the entry.
- % Not absorbing as a macro argument reduces the chance of problems
- % with catcodes occurring.
-}
-{\catcode`\@=11
-\gdef\finishentry#1{%
- \egroup % end box A
- \dimen@ = \wd\boxA % Length of text of entry
- \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup
- \unhbox\boxA
- % #1 is the page number.
- %
- % Get the width of the page numbers, and only use
- % leaders if they are present.
- \global\setbox\boxB = \hbox{#1}%
- \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
- \null\nobreak\hfill\ %
- \else
- %
- \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
- %
- \ifpdforxetex
- \pdfgettoks#1.%
- \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
- \else
- \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable #1%
- \fi
- \fi
- \egroup % end \boxA
- \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
- \noindent\unhbox\boxA\par
- \nobreak
- \else\bgroup
- % We want the text of the entries to be aligned to the left, and the
- % page numbers to be aligned to the right.
- %
- \parindent = 0pt
- \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fil
- \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus -1fill
- \rightskip = 0pt plus -1fil
- \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fill
- % Cause last line, which could consist of page numbers on their own
- % if the list of page numbers is long, to be aligned to the right.
- \parfillskip=0pt plus -1fill
- %
- \advance\rightskip by \entryrightmargin
- % Determine how far we can stretch into the margin.
- % This allows, e.g., "Appendix H GNU Free Documentation License" to
- % fit on one line in @letterpaper format.
- \ifdim\entryrightmargin>2.1em
- \dimen@i=2.1em
- \else
- \dimen@i=0em
- \fi
- \advance \parfillskip by 0pt minus 1\dimen@i
- %
- \dimen@ii = \hsize
- \advance\dimen@ii by -1\leftskip
- \advance\dimen@ii by -1\entryrightmargin
- \advance\dimen@ii by 1\dimen@i
- \ifdim\wd\boxA > \dimen@ii % If the entry doesn't fit in one line
- \ifdim\dimen@ > 0.8\dimen@ii % due to long index text
- % Try to split the text roughly evenly. \dimen@ will be the length of
- % the first line.
- \dimen@ = 0.7\dimen@
- \dimen@ii = \hsize
- \ifnum\dimen@>\dimen@ii
- % If the entry is too long (for example, if it needs more than
- % two lines), use all the space in the first line.
- \dimen@ = \dimen@ii
- \fi
- \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill % ragged right
- \advance \dimen@ by 1\rightskip
- \parshape = 2 0pt \dimen@ 0em \dimen@ii
- % Ideally we'd add a finite glue at the end of the first line only,
- % instead of using \parshape with explicit line lengths, but TeX
- % doesn't seem to provide a way to do such a thing.
- %
- % Indent all lines but the first one.
- \advance\leftskip by 1em
- \advance\parindent by -1em
- \fi\fi
- \indent % start paragraph
- \unhbox\boxA
- %
- % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
- \finalhyphendemerits = 0
- %
- % Word spacing - no stretch
- \spaceskip=\fontdimen2\font minus \fontdimen4\font
- %
- \linepenalty=1000 % Discourage line breaks.
- \hyphenpenalty=5000 % Discourage hyphenation.
- %
- \par % format the paragraph
- \egroup % The \vbox
- \fi
- \endgroup
-}}
-
-\newskip\thinshrinkable
-\skip\thinshrinkable=.15em minus .15em
-
-% Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
-% The filll stretch here overpowers both the fil and fill stretch to push
-% the page number to the right.
-\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
- \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1filll}
-
-
-\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
-
-\def\secondary{\indententry{0.5cm}}
-\def\tertiary{\indententry{1cm}}
-
-\def\indententry#1#2#3{%
- \bgroup
- \leftskip=#1
- \entry{#2}{#3}%
- \egroup
-}
-
-% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
-% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
-% the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
-\catcode`\@=11 % private names
-
-\newbox\partialpage
-\newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
-
-\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
- % If not much space left on page, start a new page.
- \ifdim\pagetotal>0.8\vsize\vfill\eject\fi
- %
- % Grab any single-column material above us.
- \output = {%
- \savetopmark
- %
- \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
- % Unvbox the main output page.
- \unvbox\PAGE
- \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
- }%
- }%
- \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
- %
- % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
- \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
- %
- % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
- % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
- % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
- % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
- % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
- %
- % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
- % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
- % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
- % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
- % as it did when we hard-coded it.
- %
- % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
- % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
- % been clobbered.
- %
- \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
- \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
- \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
- \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
- %
- % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
- % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
- % previous page.
- \advance\vsize by -\ht\partialpage
- \vsize = 2\vsize
- %
- % For the benefit of balancing columns
- \advance\baselineskip by 0pt plus 0.5pt
-}
-
-% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
-% the last, which is done by \balancecolumns.
-%
-\def\doublecolumnout{%
- %
- \savetopmark
- \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
- \dimen@ = \vsize
- \divide\dimen@ by 2
- %
- % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
- \setbox0=\vsplit\PAGE to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit\PAGE to\dimen@
- \global\advance\vsize by 2\ht\partialpage
- \onepageout\pagesofar % empty except for the first time we are called
- \unvbox\PAGE
- \penalty\outputpenalty
-}
-%
-% Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
-% followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
-\def\pagesofar{%
- \unvbox\partialpage
- %
- \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
- \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
- \hbox to\txipagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
-}
-
-
-% Finished with double columns.
-\def\enddoublecolumns{%
- % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
- % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
- % following situation:
- %
- % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
- % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
- % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
- % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
- % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
- % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
- % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
- % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
- % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
- % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
- % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
- % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
- % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
- % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
- % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
- % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
- % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
- % and the final section into the vbox of \txipageheight (see
- % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
- %
- % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
- % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
- \penalty0
- %
- \output = {%
- % Split the last of the double-column material.
- \savetopmark
- \balancecolumns
- }%
- \eject % call the \output just set
- \ifdim\pagetotal=0pt
- % Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
- % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
- % definition right away.
- \global\output=\expandafter{\the\defaultoutput}
- %
- \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
- % Leave the double-column material on the current page, no automatic
- % page break.
- \box\balancedcolumns
- %
- % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
- % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
- % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize.
- \global\vsize = \txipageheight %
- \pagegoal = \txipageheight %
- \else
- % We had some left-over material. This might happen when \doublecolumnout
- % is called in \balancecolumns. Try again.
- \expandafter\enddoublecolumns
- \fi
-}
-\newbox\balancedcolumns
-\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{shouldnt see this}%
-%
-% Only called for the last of the double column material. \doublecolumnout
-% does the others.
-\def\balancecolumns{%
- \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox\PAGE}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
- \dimen@ = \ht0
- \ifdim\dimen@<7\baselineskip
- % Don't split a short final column in two.
- \setbox2=\vbox{}%
- \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
- \else
- % double the leading vertical space
- \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
- \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
- \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
- \dimen@ii = \dimen@
- \splittopskip = \topskip
- % Loop until left column is at least as high as the right column.
- {%
- \vbadness = 10000
- \loop
- \global\setbox3 = \copy0
- \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
- \ifdim\ht1<\ht3
- \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
- \repeat
- }%
- % Now the left column is in box 1, and the right column in box 3.
- %
- % Check whether the left column has come out higher than the page itself.
- % (Note that we have doubled \vsize for the double columns, so
- % the actual height of the page is 0.5\vsize).
- \ifdim2\ht1>\vsize
- % It appears that we have been called upon to balance too much material.
- % Output some of it with \doublecolumnout, leaving the rest on the page.
- \setbox\PAGE=\box0
- \doublecolumnout
- \else
- % Compare the heights of the two columns.
- \ifdim4\ht1>5\ht3
- % Column heights are too different, so don't make their bottoms
- % flush with each other.
- \setbox2=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox3\vfill}%
- \setbox0=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox1\vfill}%
- \else
- % Make column bottoms flush with each other.
- \setbox2=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox3\unskip}%
- \setbox0=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox1\unskip}%
- \fi
- \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
- \fi
- \fi
- %
-}
-\catcode`\@ = \other
-
-
-\message{sectioning,}
-% Chapters, sections, etc.
-
-% Let's start with @part.
-\outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
-\def\partzzz#1{%
- \chapoddpage
- \null
- \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
- \begingroup
- \noindent \titlefonts\rm #1\par % the text
- \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with
- \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
- \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
- % This outputs a mark at the end of the page that clears \thischapter
- % and \thissection, as is done in \startcontents.
- \let\pchapsepmacro\relax
- \chapmacro{}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
- \chapoddpage
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
-% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
-% outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
-% numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
-% chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
-\newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
-\newcount\chapno
-\newcount\secno \secno=0
-\newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
-\newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
-
-% This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
-\newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
-%
-% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
-% We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
-% construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
-% letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
-%
-\def\appendixletter{%
- \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
- % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
- % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
- % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
- % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
- \else\char\the\appendixno
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
-
-% Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
-% and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
-% these. @section does likewise.
-\def\thischapter{}
-\def\thischapternum{}
-\def\thischaptername{}
-\def\thissection{}
-\def\thissectionnum{}
-\def\thissectionname{}
-
-\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
-\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
-
-% @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
-\def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
-
-% @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
-\def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
-
-% we only have subsub.
-\chardef\maxseclevel = 3
-%
-% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
-% To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
-\chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel
-%
-% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
-% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
-\def\chapheadtype{N}
-
-% Choose a heading macro
-% #1 is heading type
-% #2 is heading level
-% #3 is text for heading
-\def\genhead#1#2#3{%
- % Compute the abs. sec. level:
- \absseclevel=#2
- \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
- % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
- \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
- \absseclevel = 0
- \else
- \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
- \absseclevel = 3
- \fi
- \fi
- % The heading type:
- \def\headtype{#1}%
- \if \headtype U%
- \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel
- \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel
- \fi
- \else
- % Check for appendix sections:
- \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
- \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
- \else
- \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
- \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
- \fi\fi
- \fi
- % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
- \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel
- \def\headtype{U}%
- \else
- \chardef\unnlevel = 3
- \fi
- \fi
- % Now print the heading:
- \if \headtype U%
- \ifcase\absseclevel
- \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
- \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
- \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
- \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
- \fi
- \else
- \if \headtype A%
- \ifcase\absseclevel
- \appendixzzz{#3}%
- \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
- \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
- \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
- \fi
- \else
- \ifcase\absseclevel
- \chapterzzz{#3}%
- \or \seczzz{#3}%
- \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
- \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent
-}
-
-% an interface:
-\def\numhead{\genhead N}
-\def\apphead{\genhead A}
-\def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
-
-% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
-% all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
-%
-% Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
-% (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
-\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
-%
-\outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
-\def\chapterzzz#1{%
- % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
- % as an @include file.
- \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
- \global\advance\chapno by 1
- %
- % Used for \float.
- \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
- \resetallfloatnos
- %
- % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
- \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
- \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
- %
- % Write the actual heading.
- \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
- %
- % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
- \global\let\section = \numberedsec
- \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
- \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
-}
-
-\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
-%
-\def\appendixzzz#1{%
- \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
- \global\advance\appendixno by 1
- \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
- \resetallfloatnos
- %
- % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
- \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
- \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
- %
- \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
- %
- \global\let\section = \appendixsec
- \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
- \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
-}
-
-% normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
-\def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
- \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
- \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
- %
- % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
- \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
- \resetallfloatnos
- %
- % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
- % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
- % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
- % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
- % to be executed, not expanded).
- %
- % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
- % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
- % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
- % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
- % the toc entries.)
- \toks0 = {#1}%
- \message{(\the\toks0)}%
- %
- \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
- %
- \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
- \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
- \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
-}
-
-% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
-\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
- \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
- \unnmhead0{#1}%
- \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
-}
-
-% @top is like @unnumbered.
-\let\top\unnumbered
-
-% Sections.
-%
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
-\def\seczzz#1{%
- \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
-}
-
-% normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
-\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
- \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
-}
-\let\appendixsec\appendixsection
-
-% normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
-\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
- \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
-}
-
-% Subsections.
-%
-% normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
-\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
-}
-
-% normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
-\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
- {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
-}
-
-% normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
-\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
- {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
-}
-
-% Subsubsections.
-%
-% normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
-\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
- {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
-}
-
-% normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
-\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
- {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
-}
-
-% normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
-\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
- {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
-}
-
-% These macros control what the section commands do, according
-% to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
-% Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
-\let\section = \numberedsec
-\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
-\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
-
-% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
-
-\def\majorheading{%
- {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
- \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
-}
-
-\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
-\def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
- \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
- \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent
-}
-
-% @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
-\parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
-\parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
-\parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
-
-% These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
-% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
-% given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
-
-% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
-\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
-
-% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
-\newskip\chapheadingskip
-
-% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
-\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
-
-% Start a new page
-\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
-
-% \chapoddpage - start on an odd page for a new chapter
-% Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
-% get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
-% care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
-\def\chapoddpage{%
- \chappager
- \ifodd\pageno \else
- \begingroup
- \headingsoff
- \null
- \chappager
- \endgroup
- \fi
-}
-
-\parseargdef\setchapternewpage{\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
-
-\def\CHAPPAGoff{%
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
-\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsinglechapoff}}
-
-\def\CHAPPAGon{%
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
-\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
-
-\def\CHAPPAGodd{%
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
-\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
-\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
-
-\CHAPPAGon
-
-% \chapmacro - Chapter opening.
-%
-% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
-% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
-% Not used for @heading series.
-%
-% To test against our argument.
-\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
-\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
-\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
-%
-\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
- \expandafter\ifx\thisenv\titlepage\else
- \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment.
- \fi
- % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
- \let\prevchapterdefs=\currentchapterdefs
- \let\prevsectiondefs=\currentsectiondefs
- \gdef\currentsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
- \gdef\thissection{}}%
- %
- \def\temptype{#2}%
- \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
- \gdef\currentchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
- \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
- \gdef\currentchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
- \gdef\thischapter{}}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
- \toks0={#1}%
- \xdef\currentchapterdefs{%
- \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
- \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
- % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
- % commands in some of the translations.
- \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
- \noexpand\thischapternum:
- \noexpand\thischaptername}%
- }%
- \else
- \toks0={#1}%
- \xdef\currentchapterdefs{%
- \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
- \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
- % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
- % commands in some of the translations.
- \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
- \noexpand\thischapternum:
- \noexpand\thischaptername}%
- }%
- \fi\fi\fi
- %
- % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
- % the preceding space.
- \safewhatsit\domark
- %
- % Insert the chapter heading break.
- \pchapsepmacro
- %
- % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
- % between here and the heading.
- \let\prevchapterdefs=\currentchapterdefs
- \let\prevsectiondefs=\currentsectiondefs
- \domark
- %
- {%
- \chapfonts \rm
- \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading % give better error message
- %
- % Have to define \currentsection before calling \donoderef, because the
- % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
- % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
- \gdef\currentsection{#1}%
- %
- % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
- % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
- \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
- \def\toctype{unnchap}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
- \def\toctype{omit}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
- \def\toctype{app}%
- \else
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
- \def\toctype{numchap}%
- \fi\fi\fi
- %
- % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
- % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
- % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
- \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
- %
- % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
- % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
- % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
- % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
- % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
- \donoderef{#2}%
- %
- % Typeset the actual heading.
- \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
- \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
- \unhbox0 #1\par}%
- }%
- \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
- \nobreak
-}
-
-% @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
-\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
-\def\centerparameters{%
- \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
- \leftskip = \rightskip
- \parfillskip = 0pt
-}
-
-
-% Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
-% call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
-%
-\newskip\secheadingskip
-\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
-
-% Subsection titles.
-\newskip\subsecheadingskip
-\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
-
-% Subsubsection titles.
-\def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
-\def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
-
-
-% Print any size, any type, section title.
-%
-% #1 is the text of the title,
-% #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec),
-% #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc),
-% #4 is the section number.
-%
-\def\seckeyword{sec}
-%
-\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
- {%
- \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
- \def\temptype{#3}%
- %
- % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an
- % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is
- % dubious), but not the others.
- \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else
- \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment.
- \fi
- \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading
- %
- % Switch to the right set of fonts.
- \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
- %
- % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
- \let\prevsectiondefs=\currentsectiondefs
- \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
- \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
- \gdef\currentsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
- \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
- \fi
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
- % Don't redefine \thissection.
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
- \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
- \toks0={#1}%
- \xdef\currentsectiondefs{%
- \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
- \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
- % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
- % commands in some of the translations.
- \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
- \noexpand\thissectionnum:
- \noexpand\thissectionname}%
- }%
- \fi
- \else
- \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
- \toks0={#1}%
- \xdef\currentsectiondefs{%
- \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
- \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
- % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
- % commands in some of the translations.
- \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
- \noexpand\thissectionnum:
- \noexpand\thissectionname}%
- }%
- \fi
- \fi\fi\fi
- %
- % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
- % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
- % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
- \par
- %
- % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
- % the preceding space.
- \safewhatsit\domark
- %
- % Insert space above the heading.
- \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
- %
- % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
- % between here and the heading.
- \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\currentsectiondefs
- \domark
- %
- % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
- \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
- \def\toctype{unn}%
- \gdef\currentsection{#1}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
- % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
- % and don't redefine \currentsection.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
- \def\toctype{omit}%
- \let\sectionlevel=\empty
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
- \def\toctype{app}%
- \gdef\currentsection{#1}%
- \else
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
- \def\toctype{num}%
- \gdef\currentsection{#1}%
- \fi\fi\fi
- %
- % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
- \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
- %
- % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
- % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
- \donoderef{#3}%
- %
- % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
- % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
- % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
- % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
- % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
- % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
- \nobreak
- %
- % Output the actual section heading.
- \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
- \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
- \unhbox0 #1}%
- }%
- % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
- % Don't allow stretch, though.
- \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
- %
- % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
- % was followed by glue.
- \nobreak
- %
- % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
- % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
- % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next
- % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
- % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
- % obscuring the section heading with something else.
- \vskip-\parskip
- %
- % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
- % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
- % and do the needful.
- \penalty 10001
-}
-
-
-\message{toc,}
-% Table of contents.
-\newwrite\tocfile
-
-% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
-% Called from @chapter, etc.
-%
-% Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
-% We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
-% arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
-% read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
-% destination to jump to.
-%
-% We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
-% any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
-% But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
-% table of contents chapter openings themselves.
-%
-\newif\iftocfileopened
-\def\omitkeyword{omit}%
-%
-\def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
- \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
- \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
- \iftocfileopened\else
- \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
- \global\tocfileopenedtrue
- \fi
- %
- \iflinks
- {\atdummies
- \edef\temp{%
- \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
- \temp
- }%
- \fi
- \fi
- %
- % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
- % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
- % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
- % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
- % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
- % `1', and two named `2'.
- \ifpdforxetex
- \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue
- \fi
-}
-
-
-% These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
-% fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
-% with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
-%
-\def\activecatcodes{%
- \catcode`\"=\active
- \catcode`\$=\active
- \catcode`\<=\active
- \catcode`\>=\active
- \catcode`\\=\active
- \catcode`\^=\active
- \catcode`\_=\active
- \catcode`\|=\active
- \catcode`\~=\active
-}
-
-
-% Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
-\def\readtocfile{%
- \setupdatafile
- \activecatcodes
- \input \tocreadfilename
-}
-
-\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
-\newcount\savepageno
-\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
-
-% Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
-%
-\def\startcontents#1{%
- % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
- % start on an odd page, unlike chapters.
- \contentsalignmacro
- \immediate\closeout\tocfile
- %
- % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
- % It is abundantly clear what they are.
- \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
- %
- \savepageno = \pageno
- \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
- \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
- \entryrightmargin=\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
- %
- % Roman numerals for page numbers.
- \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
- \def\thistitle{}% no title in double-sided headings
- % Record where the Roman numerals started.
- \ifnum\romancount=0 \global\romancount=\pagecount \fi
-}
-
-% redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
-% \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
-%
-\def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
-
-% Normal (long) toc.
-%
-\def\contents{%
- \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
- \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \readtocfile
- \fi
- \vfill \eject
- \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \pdfmakeoutlines
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \endgroup
- \contentsendroman
-}
-
-% And just the chapters.
-\def\summarycontents{%
- \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
- %
- \let\partentry = \shortpartentry
- \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
- \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
- \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
- % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
- \secfonts
- \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
- \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
- \rm
- \hyphenpenalty = 10000
- \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
- \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
- \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \readtocfile
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \vfill \eject
- \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
- \endgroup
- \contentsendroman
-}
-\let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
-
-% Get ready to use Arabic numerals again
-\def\contentsendroman{%
- \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
- \global\pageno = \savepageno
- %
- % If \romancount > \arabiccount, the contents are at the end of the
- % document. Otherwise, advance where the Arabic numerals start for
- % the page numbers.
- \ifnum\romancount>\arabiccount\else\global\arabiccount=\pagecount\fi
-}
-
-% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
-% The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
-%
-\def\shortchaplabel#1{%
- % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
- % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
- % But use \hss just in case.
- % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
- % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
- %
- % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
- % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
- % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
- % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
- % there are before deciding ...
- \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
-}
-
-% These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
-% The first argument is the chapter or section name.
-% The last argument is the page number.
-% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
-
-% Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
-% exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
-% Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
-\def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}}
-\def\partentry#1#2#3#4{%
- % Add stretch and a bonus for breaking the page before the part heading.
- % This reduces the chance of the page being broken immediately after the
- % part heading, before a following chapter heading.
- \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
- \penalty-300
- \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
- \dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}%
-}
-%
-% Parts, in the short toc.
-\def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
- \penalty-300
- \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip
- \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
-}
-
-% Chapters, in the main contents.
-\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-
-% Chapters, in the short toc.
-% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
-\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
- \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
-}
-
-% Appendices, in the main contents.
-% Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
-%
-\def\appendixbox#1{%
- % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
- \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
-%
-\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\hskip.7em#1}{#4}}
-
-% Unnumbered chapters.
-\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
-\def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
-
-% Sections.
-\def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-\let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
-\def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
-
-% Subsections.
-\def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-\let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
-\def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
-
-% And subsubsections.
-\def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-\let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
-\def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
-
-% This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
-% Same as \defaultparindent.
-\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
-
-% Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
-% page number.
-%
-% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
-% if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
-\def\dochapentry#1#2{%
- \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
- \begingroup
- % Move the page numbers slightly to the right
- \advance\entryrightmargin by -0.05em
- \chapentryfonts
- \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
- \endgroup
- \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
-}
-
-\def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
- \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
- \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
-\endgroup}
-
-\def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
- \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
- \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
-\endgroup}
-
-\def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
- \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
- \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
-\endgroup}
-
-% We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
-\let\tocentry = \entry
-
-% Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
-\def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
-
-\def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
-\def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
-
-\def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
-\def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
-\def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
-\def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
-
-
-\message{environments,}
-% @foo ... @end foo.
-
-% @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
-% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
-% But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
-
-\envdef\tex{%
- \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
- \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
- \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
- \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
- \catcode `\%=14
- \catcode `\+=\other
- \catcode `\"=\other
- \catcode `\|=\other
- \catcode `\<=\other
- \catcode `\>=\other
- \catcode `\`=\other
- \catcode `\'=\other
- %
- % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
- % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
- \mathactive
- %
- % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file.
- \let\b=\ptexb
- \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
- \let\c=\ptexc
- \let\,=\ptexcomma
- \let\.=\ptexdot
- \let\dots=\ptexdots
- \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
- \let\!=\ptexexclam
- \let\i=\ptexi
- \let\indent=\ptexindent
- \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
- \let\{=\ptexlbrace
- \let\+=\tabalign
- \let\}=\ptexrbrace
- \let\/=\ptexslash
- \let\sp=\ptexsp
- \let\*=\ptexstar
- %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode
- \let\t=\ptext
- \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % we've made it outer
- \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
- %
- \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
- \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
- \def\@{@}%
-}
-% There is no need to define \Etex.
-
-% Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
-% @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
-% including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
-
-% Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
-\newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
-
-% This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
-% such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
-% have any width.
-\def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
-
-% This space is always present above and below environments.
-\newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
-
-% Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
-% to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
-% is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
-% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
-%
-\def\aboveenvbreak{{%
- % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
- % \sectionheading, q.v.
- \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
- \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
- \endgraf
- \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
- \removelastskip
- \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
- % Penalize breaking before the environment, because preceding text
- % often leads into it.
- \penalty100
- \fi
- \vskip\envskipamount
- \fi
- \fi
-}}
-
-\def\afterenvbreak{{%
- % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
- % \sectionheading, q.v.
- \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
- \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
- \endgraf
- \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
- \removelastskip
- % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
- % or better ...
- \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
- \vskip\envskipamount
- \fi
- \fi
-}}
-
-% \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
-% also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
-\let\nonarrowing=\relax
-
-% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
-% environment contents.
-
-%
-\def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
-\def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
-\def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
-\def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
-\def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
- \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
- \hskip\rskip}}
-\def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
- \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
- \hskip\rskip}}
-%
-\newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
-
-% only require the font if @cartouche is actually used
-\def\cartouchefontdefs{%
- \font\circle=lcircle10\relax
- \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
-}
-\newdimen\circthick
-\newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
-\newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
-
-
-\envdef\cartouche{%
- \cartouchefontdefs
- \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
- \startsavinginserts
- \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
- \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
- \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
- \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
- \cartouter=\hsize
- \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
- % side, and for 6pt waste from
- % each corner char, and rule thickness
- \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
- %
- % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
- % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
- % collide with the section heading.
- \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
- %
- \setbox\groupbox=\vbox\bgroup
- \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
- \carttop
- \hbox\bgroup
- \hskip\lskip
- \vrule\kern3pt
- \vbox\bgroup
- \kern3pt
- \hsize=\cartinner
- \baselineskip=\normbskip
- \lineskip=\normlskip
- \parskip=\normpskip
- \vskip -\parskip
- \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
-}
-\def\Ecartouche{%
- \ifhmode\par\fi
- \kern3pt
- \egroup
- \kern3pt\vrule
- \hskip\rskip
- \egroup
- \cartbot
- \egroup
- \addgroupbox
- \checkinserts
-}
-
-
-% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
-% inside a group.
-\newdimen\nonfillparindent
-\def\nonfillstart{%
- \aboveenvbreak
- \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy
- \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
- \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
- \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
- \parskip = 0pt
- % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
- % the normal \indent.
- \nonfillparindent=\parindent
- \parindent = 0pt
- \let\indent\nonfillindent
- %
- \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
- \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
- \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
- \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
- \else
- \let\nonarrowing = \relax
- \fi
- \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
-}
-
-\begingroup
-\obeyspaces
-% We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
-% @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
-% active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
-% @indent.
-\gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
-\gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
-\ifx\temp %
-\expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
-\else%
-\leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
-\fi%
-}%
-\endgroup
-\def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
-\def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
-
-% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
-% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
-% This affects the following displayed environments:
-% @example, @display, @format, @lisp
-%
-\def\smallword{small}
-\def\nosmallword{nosmall}
-\let\SETdispenvsize\relax
-\def\setnormaldispenv{%
- \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
- % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
- % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
- % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
- % to change the fonts afterward.
- \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
- \smallexamplefonts \rm
- \fi
-}
-\def\setsmalldispenv{%
- \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
- \else
- \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
- \smallexamplefonts \rm
- \fi
-}
-
-% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
-% Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
-\def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
- \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
- \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
- \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
- \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
-}
-
-% Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
-\def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
- \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
- \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
-}
-%
-% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
-% @example: same as @lisp.
-%
-% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
-% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
-%
-\maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{%
- \nonfillstart
- \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
- \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
- \gobble % eat return
-}
-% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
-%
-\makedispenvdef{display}{%
- \nonfillstart
- \gobble
-}
-
-% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
-%
-\makedispenvdef{format}{%
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \nonfillstart
- \gobble
-}
-
-% @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
-\envdef\flushleft{%
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \nonfillstart
- \gobble
-}
-\let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
-
-% @flushright.
-%
-\envdef\flushright{%
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \nonfillstart
- \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax
- \gobble
-}
-\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
-
-
-% @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
-% justification. From plain.tex.
-\envdef\raggedright{%
- \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
-}
-\let\Eraggedright\par
-
-\envdef\raggedleft{%
- \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
- \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
- \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
- % badness reporting.
-}
-\let\Eraggedleft\par
-
-\envdef\raggedcenter{%
- \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
- \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
- \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
- % badness reporting.
-}
-\let\Eraggedcenter\par
-
-
-% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
-% and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
-% we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
-% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
-%
-\makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart}
-%
-\def\quotationstart{%
- \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
- \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
- \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
- \fi
- \parsearg\quotationlabel
-}
-
-% We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
-% doing normal filling.
-%
-\def\Equotation{%
- \par
- \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
- % indent a bit.
- \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
- \fi
- {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
-}
-\def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
-
-% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
-\def\quotationlabel#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\empty \else
- {\bf #1: }%
- \fi
-}
-
-% @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
-% has no optional argument.
-%
-\makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart}
-%
-\def\indentedblockstart{%
- {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
- \parindent=0pt
- %
- % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
- \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
- \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
- \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
- \else
- \let\nonarrowing = \relax
- \fi
-}
-
-% Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
-%
-\def\Eindentedblock{%
- \par
- {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
-}
-\def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
-
-
-% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
-% If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
-% we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
-% `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
-%
-% [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
-%
-% [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
-% active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
-% verbatim line.
-\def\dospecials{%
- \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
- \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
- \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
- % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
- % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
- % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
- %\do\`\do\'%
-}
-%
-% [Knuth] p. 380
-\def\uncatcodespecials{%
- \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
-%
-% Setup for the @verb command.
-%
-% Eight spaces for a tab
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\^^I=\active
- \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
-\endgroup
-%
-\def\setupverb{%
- \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
- \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
- \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
- \tabeightspaces
- % Respect line breaks,
- % print special symbols as themselves, and
- % make each space count
- % must do in this order:
- \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
-}
-
-% Setup for the @verbatim environment
-%
-% Real tab expansion.
-\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
-%
-% We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
-% tabs.
-\newbox\verbbox
-\def\starttabbox{\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup}
-%
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\^^I=\active
- \gdef\tabexpand{%
- \catcode`\^^I=\active
- \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
- \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
- \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw
- \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
- \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
- \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox
- \leavevmode\box\verbbox \starttabbox
- }%
- }
-\endgroup
-
-% start the verbatim environment.
-\def\setupverbatim{%
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \nonfillstart
- \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
- \def\par{\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf\starttabbox}%
- \tabexpand
- \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
- % Respect line breaks,
- % print special symbols as themselves, and
- % make each space count.
- % Must do in this order:
- \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
-}
-
-% Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
-% delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
-% right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
-%
-% \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
-%
-% [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
-\begingroup
- \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
- \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
-\endgroup
-%
-\def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
-%
-%
-% Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
-% the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
-%
-% \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
-%
-% For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
-% because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
-% we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
-%
-% Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
-%
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\ =\active
- \obeylines %
- % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
- % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
- % line in the output.
- \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{%
- \starttabbox#2\egroup\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
- % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
- % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
- % The \egroup ends the \verbbox started at the end of the last line in
- % the block.
-\endgroup
-%
-\envdef\verbatim{%
- \setupverbatim\doverbatim
-}
-\let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
-
-
-% @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
-%
-\def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
-%
-\def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \setupverbatim
- {%
- \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
- \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}%
- \edef\tmp{\noexpand\input #1 }
- \expandafter
- }\expandafter\starttabbox\tmp\egroup
- \afterenvbreak
- }%
-}
-
-% @copying ... @end copying.
-% Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
-%
-% We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
-% Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
-% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
-% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
-% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
-% possible is desirable.
-%
-\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
-\def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
-%
-\def\insertcopying{%
- \begingroup
- \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
- \scanexp\copyingtext
- \endgroup
-}
-
-
-\message{defuns,}
-% @defun etc.
-
-\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
-\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
-\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
-\newcount\defunpenalty
-
-% Start the processing of @deffn:
-\def\startdefun{%
- \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
- \medbreak
- \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
- % following @def command, see below.
- \else
- % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
- % which is there to keep the function description together with its
- % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
- % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
- % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
- % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
- % a break between a section heading and a defun.
- %
- % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
- % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
- % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
- % @def command.
- \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
- %
- % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
- % But do insert the glue.
- \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
- \fi
- %
- \parindent=0in
- \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
- \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-}
-
-\def\dodefunx#1{%
- % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
- \checkenv#1%
- %
- % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
- % It's not a great place, though.
- \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
- %
- % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
- \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
-}
-\def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
-
-% \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
-%
-\def\printdefunline#1#2{%
- \begingroup
- % call \deffnheader:
- #1#2 \endheader
- % common ending:
- \interlinepenalty = 10000
- \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax
- \endgraf
- \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
- \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
- % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
- % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
- \checkparencounts
- \endgroup
-}
-
-\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
-
-% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
-% the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
-%
-\def\makedefun#1{%
- \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
- \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
- \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
- \temp
-}
-
-% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader { (defn. of \deffnheader) }
-%
-% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
-% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
-%
-\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
- \envdef#1{%
- \startdefun
- \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
- \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
- }%
- \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
- \def#3%
-}
-
-\newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
-\newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
-
-% @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
-% are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
-% @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
-%
-\parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\onword
- \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
- = \empty
- \else\ifx\temp\offword
- \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
- = \relax
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp',
- must be on|off}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
-%
-% If SUBTOPIC is present, precede it with a space, and call \doind.
-% (At some time during the 20th century, this made a two-level entry in an
-% index such as the operation index. Nobody seemed to notice the change in
-% behaviour though.)
-\def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
- \def\thirdarg{#3}%
- \ifx\thirdarg\empty
- \doind{#1}{#2}%
- \else
- \doind{#1}{#2\space#3}%
- \fi
-}
-
-% Untyped functions:
-
-% @deffn category name args
-\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
-
-% @deffn category class name args
-\makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
-
-% \defopon {category on}class name args
-\def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
-
-% \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
-%
-\def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
- \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
- \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
-}
-
-% Typed functions:
-
-% @deftypefn category type name args
-\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
-
-% @deftypeop category class type name args
-\makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
-
-% \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
-\def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
-
-% \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
-%
-\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
- \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
- \doingtypefntrue
- \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
-}
-
-% Typed variables:
-
-% @deftypevr category type var args
-\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
-
-% @deftypecv category class type var args
-\makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
-
-% \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
-\def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
-
-% \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
-%
-\def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
- \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
- \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
-}
-
-% Untyped variables:
-
-% @defvr category var args
-\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
-
-% @defcv category class var args
-\makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
-
-% \defcvof {category of}class var args
-\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
-
-% Types:
-
-% @deftp category name args
-\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
- \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
- \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
-}
-
-% Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
-\makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
-\makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
-\makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
-\makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
-\makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
-\makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
-\makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
-\makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
-\makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
-\makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
-\makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
-
-% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
-% #1 is the category, such as "Function".
-% #2 is the return type, if any.
-% #3 is the function name.
-%
-% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
-%
-\def\defname#1#2#3{%
- \par
- % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
- \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
- %
- % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
- % on a line by itself.
- \rettypeownlinefalse
- \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
- % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else
- \rettypeownlinetrue
- \fi
- \fi
- %
- % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
- % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
- % just below it.
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
- %
- % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
- % least two.
- \tempnum = 2
- %
- % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
- % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
- \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
- %
- % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
- \ifrettypeownline
- \advance\tempnum by 1
- \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}%
- \else
- \def\maybeshapeline{}%
- \fi
- %
- % The continuations:
- \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
- %
- % The final paragraph shape:
- \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
- %
- % Put the category name at the right margin.
- \noindent
- \hbox to 0pt{%
- \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
- % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
- \kern\leftskip
- % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
- }%
- %
- % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
- \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
- \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
- {%
- % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
- % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
- % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
- % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
- % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
- % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
- % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
- % one has made identifiers using them :).
- \df \tt
- \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
- \ifx\temp\empty\else
- \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
- \ifrettypeownline
- % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
- \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
- \else
- \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
- \fi
- \fi % no return type
- #3% output function name
- }%
- {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \rmfont
- %
- \boldbrax
- % arguments will be output next, if any.
-}
-
-% Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
-% tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
-% the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
-% distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
-%
-\def\defunargs#1{%
- % use sl by default (not ttsl),
- % tt for the names.
- \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
- %
- % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
- % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so
- % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
- % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
- % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`.
- \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
- #1%
- \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
-}
-
-% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
-%
-\def\activeparens{%
- \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
- \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
- \catcode`\&=\active
-}
-
-% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
-\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
-
-% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
-% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
-% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
-{
- \activeparens
- \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
- \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
- \global\let& = \&
-
- \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
- \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
-}
-\let\ampchar\&
-
-\newcount\parencount
-
-% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
-\newif\ifampseen
-\def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
-
-\def\parenfont{%
- \ifampseen
- % At the first level, print parens in roman,
- % otherwise use the default font.
- \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
- \else
- % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
- % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
- \sf
- \fi
-}
-\def\infirstlevel#1{%
- \ifampseen
- \ifnum\parencount=1
- #1%
- \fi
- \fi
-}
-\def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
-
-\def\opnr{%
- \global\advance\parencount by 1
- {\parenfont(}%
- \infirstlevel \bfafterword
-}
-\def\clnr{%
- {\parenfont)}%
- \infirstlevel \sl
- \global\advance\parencount by -1
-}
-
-\newcount\brackcount
-\def\lbrb{%
- \global\advance\brackcount by 1
- {\bf[}%
-}
-\def\rbrb{%
- {\bf]}%
- \global\advance\brackcount by -1
-}
-
-\def\checkparencounts{%
- \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
- \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
-}
-% these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
-% has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
-\def\badparencount{%
- \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
- \global\parencount=0
-}
-\def\badbrackcount{%
- \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
- \global\brackcount=0
-}
-
-
-\message{macros,}
-% @macro.
-
-% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
-% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
-\ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
- \newwrite\macscribble
- \def\scantokens#1{%
- \toks0={#1}%
- \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
- \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
- \immediate\closeout\macscribble
- \input \jobname.tmp
- }
-\fi
-
-% Used at the time of macro expansion.
-% Argument is macro body with arguments substituted
-\def\scanmacro#1{%
- \newlinechar`\^^M
- \def\xeatspaces{\eatspaces}%
- %
- % Process the macro body under the current catcode regime.
- \scantokens{#1@comment}%
- %
- % The \comment is to remove the \newlinechar added by \scantokens, and
- % can be noticed by \parsearg. Note \c isn't used because this means cedilla
- % in math mode.
-}
-
-% Used for copying and captions
-\def\scanexp#1{%
- \expandafter\scanmacro\expandafter{#1}%
-}
-
-\newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
-\newtoks\macname % Macro name
-\newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
-
-% List of all defined macros in the form
-% \commondummyword\macro1\commondummyword\macro2...
-% Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
-% if there is a need.
-\def\macrolist{}
-
-% Add the macro to \macrolist
-\def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
-\def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\commondummyword#1}%
- \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
-}
-
-% Utility routines.
-% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
-% \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
-% (except of course we have to play expansion games).
-%
-\def\cslet#1#2{%
- \expandafter\let
- \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
- \csname#2\endcsname
-}
-
-% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
-% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
-{\catcode`\@=11
-\gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
-\gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
-\gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
-\def\unbrace#1{#1}
-\unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
-}
-
-% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
-{\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
-\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
-\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
-\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
-}
-
-% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
-% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
-% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
-% to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
-%
-% Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
-% them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
-% confine the change to the current group.
-%
-% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
-% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
-% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
-%
-\def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
- \catcode`\"=\other
- \catcode`\+=\other
- \catcode`\<=\other
- \catcode`\>=\other
- \catcode`\^=\other
- \catcode`\_=\other
- \catcode`\|=\other
- \catcode`\~=\other
- \passthroughcharstrue
-}
-
-\def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
- \scanctxt
- \catcode`\@=\other
- \catcode`\\=\other
- \catcode`\^^M=\other
-}
-
-\def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
- \scanctxt
- \catcode`\ =\other
- \catcode`\@=\other
- \catcode`\{=\other
- \catcode`\}=\other
- \catcode`\^^M=\other
- \usembodybackslash
-}
-
-% Used when scanning braced macro arguments. Note, however, that catcode
-% changes here are ineffectual if the macro invocation was nested inside
-% an argument to another Texinfo command.
-\def\macroargctxt{%
- \scanctxt
- \catcode`\ =\active
- \catcode`\@=\other
- \catcode`\^^M=\other
- \catcode`\\=\active
-}
-
-\def\macrolineargctxt{% used for whole-line arguments without braces
- \scanctxt
- \catcode`\@=\other
- \catcode`\{=\other
- \catcode`\}=\other
-}
-
-% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
-% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
-% where N is the macro parameter number.
-% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
-% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
-%
-{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
- @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
- @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
-}
-\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
-
-\def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 }
-
-\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
-\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
-
-\def\macroxxx#1{%
- \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
- \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
- \paramno=0\relax
- \else
- \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
- \if\paramno>256\relax
- \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments}
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
- \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
- \else
- \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
- \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
- \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
- \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
- \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
- \fi
- \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
- \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
- \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
- \fi}
-
-\parseargdef\unmacro{%
- \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
- \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
- \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
- % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
- \begingroup
- \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
- \let\commondummyword\unmacrodo
- \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
- \endgroup
- \else
- \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
- \fi
-}
-
-% Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
-% macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
-%
-\def\unmacrodo#1{%
- \ifx #1\relax
- % remove this
- \else
- \noexpand\commondummyword \noexpand#1%
- \fi
-}
-
-% \getargs -- Parse the arguments to a @macro line. Set \macname to
-% the name of the macro, and \argl to the braced argument list.
-\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
-\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
-\def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
-\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
-% This made use of the feature that if the last token of a
-% <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
-% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
-
-% Parse the optional {params} list to @macro or @rmacro.
-% Set \paramno to the number of arguments,
-% and \paramlist to a parameter text for the macro (e.g. #1,#2,#3 for a
-% three-param macro.) Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH in the params
-% list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If there are
-% less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
-% is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
-% defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
-%
-% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
-%
-% If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used: see
-% \parsemmanyargdef.
-%
-\def\parsemargdef#1;{%
- \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
- \let\hash\relax
- % \hash is redefined to `#' later to get it into definitions
- \let\xeatspaces\relax
- \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,%
- \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else
- \paramno0\relax
- \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments
- \fi
-}
-\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
- \if#1;\let\next=\relax
- \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
- \advance\paramno by 1
- \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
- {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
- \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
- \fi\next}
-
-% \parsemacbody, \parsermacbody
-%
-% Read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. (They're different since
-% rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
-%
-% We are in \macrobodyctxt, and the \xdef causes backslashshes in the macro
-% body to be transformed.
-% Set \macrobody to the body of the macro, and call \defmacro.
-%
-{\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsemacbody#1@end macro{%
-\xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
-{\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro{%
-\xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
-
-% Make @ a letter, so that we can make private-to-Texinfo macro names.
-\edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@}
-\catcode `@=11\relax
-
-%%%%%%%%%%%%%% Code for > 10 arguments only %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
-
-% If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
-% hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
-% processed again to replace the arguments.
-%
-% In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
-% argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
-% the catcode regime under which the body was input).
-%
-% If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
-% arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error).
-%
-% In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
-% list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
-% each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
-% in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
-% are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
-% twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
-\def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{%
- \if#1;\let\next=\relax
- \else
- \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@
- \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
- \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
- \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}%
- % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
- % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
- % \xdef .
- \expandafter\edef\tempa
- {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
- \advance\paramno by 1\relax
- \fi\next}
-
-
-\let\endargs@\relax
-\let\nil@\relax
-\def\nilm@{\nil@}%
-\long\def\nillm@{\nil@}%
-
-% This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
-% definition. It gets all the arguments' values and assigns them to macros
-% macarg.ARGNAME
-%
-% #1 is the macro name
-% #2 is the list of argument names
-% #3 is the list of argument values
-\def\getargvals@#1#2#3{%
- \def\macargdeflist@{}%
- \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
- \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}%
- \def\macroname{#1}%
- \begingroup
- \macroargctxt
- \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}%
- \def\@tempa{#3}%
- \ifx\@tempa\empty
- \setemptyargvalues@
- \else
- \getargvals@@
- \fi
-}
-\def\getargvals@@{%
- \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
- % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
- \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}%
- \fi
- \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
- \else
- \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
- % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
- % macros to empty.
- \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
- \else
- % pop current arg name into \@tempb
- \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}%
- \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}%
- % pop current argument value into \@tempc
- \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}%
- \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
- % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
- % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
- \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}%
- \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax
- \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{%
- \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}%
- \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}%
- \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@
- \let\next\getargvals@@
- \fi
- \fi
- \next
-}
-
-\def\push@#1#2{%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
- \expandafter#1#2}%
-}
-
-% Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
-% in macro \@tempa.
-%
-\def\macvalstoargs@{%
- % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
- % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
- % values into respective token registers.
- %
- % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
- \begingroup
- \paramno0\relax
- % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
- % value into a new token list register \toks#N
- \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,%
- % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
- % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
- % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
- \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}%
- % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
- % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
- % group.
- \expandafter
- \endgroup
- \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}%
- }
-
-% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
-%
-\def\macargexpandinbody@{%
- \expandafter
- \endgroup
- \macargdeflist@
- % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
- % is in \@tempa .
- \macvalstoargs@
- % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
- % with \@tempb .
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname
- % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
- % \egroup .
- \ifx\@tempb\gobble
- \let\@tempc\relax
- \else
- \let\@tempc\egroup
- \fi
- % And now we do the real job:
- \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}%
- \@tempd
-}
-
-\def\putargsintokens@#1,{%
- \if#1;\let\next\relax
- \else
- \let\next\putargsintokens@
- % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
- % alias \@tempb .
- \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno
- % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname
- \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}%
- \advance\paramno by 1\relax
- \fi
- \next
-}
-
-% Trailing missing arguments are set to empty.
-%
-\def\setemptyargvalues@{%
- \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
- \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
- \else
- \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@
- \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
- \fi
- \next
-}
-
-\def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{%
- \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{%
- \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}%
- \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@
- \def\paramlist{#2}%
-}
-
-% #1 is the element target macro
-% #2 is the list macro
-% #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
-\def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
- \def#1{#3}%
- \def#2{#4}%
-}
-\long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
- \long\def#1{#3}%
- \long\def#2{#4}%
-}
-
-
-%%%%%%%%%%%%%% End of code for > 10 arguments %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
-
-
-% This defines a Texinfo @macro or @rmacro, called by \parsemacbody.
-% \macrobody has the body of the macro in it, with placeholders for
-% its parameters, looking like "\xeatspaces{\hash 1}".
-% \paramno is the number of parameters
-% \paramlist is a TeX parameter text, e.g. "#1,#2,#3,"
-% There are four cases: macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments.
-% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
-% they're defined in: @include reads the file inside a group.
-%
-\def\defmacro{%
- \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
- \ifnum\paramno=1
- \def\xeatspaces##1{##1}%
- % This removes the pair of braces around the argument. We don't
- % use \eatspaces, because this can cause ends of lines to be lost
- % when the argument to \eatspaces is read, leading to line-based
- % commands like "@itemize" not being read correctly.
- \else
- \let\xeatspaces\relax % suppress expansion
- \fi
- \ifcase\paramno
- % 0
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup
- \noexpand\spaceisspace
- \noexpand\endlineisspace
- \noexpand\expandafter % skip any whitespace after the macro name.
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{%
- \egroup
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
- \or % 1
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup
- \noexpand\braceorline
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
- \egroup
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}%
- }%
- \else % at most 9
- \ifnum\paramno<10\relax
- % @MACNAME sets the context for reading the macro argument
- % @MACNAME@@ gets the argument, processes backslashes and appends a
- % comma.
- % @MACNAME@@@ removes braces surrounding the argument list.
- % @MACNAME@@@@ scans the macro body with arguments substituted.
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup
- \noexpand\expandafter % This \expandafter skip any spaces after the
- \noexpand\macroargctxt % macro before we change the catcode of space.
- \noexpand\expandafter
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname##1{%
- \noexpand\passargtomacro
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{##1,}}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname ##1}%
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\xdef
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname\paramlist{%
- \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
- \else % 10 or more:
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
- }%
- \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\macrobody
- \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble
- \fi
- \fi}
-
-\catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax % end private-to-Texinfo catcodes
-
-\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
-
-
-%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
-%
-{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=13 % We need to manipulate \ so use @ as escape
-@catcode`@_=11 % private names
-@catcode`@!=11 % used as argument separator
-
-% \passargtomacro#1#2 -
-% Call #1 with a list of tokens #2, with any doubled backslashes in #2
-% compressed to one.
-%
-% This implementation works by expansion, and not execution (so we cannot use
-% \def or similar). This reduces the risk of this failing in contexts where
-% complete expansion is done with no execution (for example, in writing out to
-% an auxiliary file for an index entry).
-%
-% State is kept in the input stream: the argument passed to
-% @look_ahead, @gobble_and_check_finish and @add_segment is
-%
-% THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT ! {PENDING_BS} NEXT_TOKEN (... rest of input)
-%
-% where:
-% THE_MACRO - name of the macro we want to call
-% ARG_RESULT - argument list we build to pass to that macro
-% PENDING_BS - either a backslash or nothing
-% NEXT_TOKEN - used to look ahead in the input stream to see what's coming next
-
-@gdef@passargtomacro#1#2{%
- @add_segment #1!{}@relax#2\@_finish\%
-}
-@gdef@_finish{@_finishx} @global@let@_finishx@relax
-
-% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
-% #2 - PENDING_BS
-% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
-% #4 used to look ahead
-%
-% If the next token is not a backslash, process the rest of the argument;
-% otherwise, remove the next token.
-@gdef@look_ahead#1!#2#3#4{%
- @ifx#4\%
- @expandafter@gobble_and_check_finish
- @else
- @expandafter@add_segment
- @fi#1!{#2}#4#4%
-}
-
-% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
-% #2 - PENDING_BS
-% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
-% #4 should be a backslash, which is gobbled.
-% #5 looks ahead
-%
-% Double backslash found. Add a single backslash, and look ahead.
-@gdef@gobble_and_check_finish#1!#2#3#4#5{%
- @add_segment#1\!{}#5#5%
-}
-
-@gdef@is_fi{@fi}
-
-% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
-% #2 - PENDING_BS
-% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
-% #4 is input stream until next backslash
-%
-% Input stream is either at the start of the argument, or just after a
-% backslash sequence, either a lone backslash, or a doubled backslash.
-% NEXT_TOKEN contains the first token in the input stream: if it is \finish,
-% finish; otherwise, append to ARG_RESULT the segment of the argument up until
-% the next backslash. PENDING_BACKSLASH contains a backslash to represent
-% a backslash just before the start of the input stream that has not been
-% added to ARG_RESULT.
-@gdef@add_segment#1!#2#3#4\{%
-@ifx#3@_finish
- @call_the_macro#1!%
-@else
- % append the pending backslash to the result, followed by the next segment
- @expandafter@is_fi@look_ahead#1#2#4!{\}@fi
- % this @fi is discarded by @look_ahead.
- % we can't get rid of it with \expandafter because we don't know how
- % long #4 is.
-}
-
-% #1 - THE_MACRO
-% #2 - ARG_RESULT
-% #3 discards the res of the conditional in @add_segment, and @is_fi ends the
-% conditional.
-@gdef@call_the_macro#1#2!#3@fi{@is_fi #1{#2}}
-
-}
-%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
-
-% \braceorline MAC is used for a one-argument macro MAC. It checks
-% whether the next non-whitespace character is a {. It sets the context
-% for reading the argument (slightly different in the two cases). Then,
-% to read the argument, in the whole-line case, it then calls the regular
-% \parsearg MAC; in the lbrace case, it calls \passargtomacro MAC.
-%
-\def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
-\def\braceorlinexxx{%
- \ifx\nchar\bgroup
- \macroargctxt
- \expandafter\passargtomacro
- \else
- \macrolineargctxt\expandafter\parsearg
- \fi \macnamexxx}
-
-
-% @alias.
-% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
-% sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
-%
-\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
-\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
-\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
- {%
- \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
- \addtomacrolist{#1}%
- \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
- }%
- \next
-}
-
-
-\message{cross references,}
-
-\newwrite\auxfile
-\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
-\newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
-
-% @inforef is relatively simple.
-\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
-\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{%
- \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
- node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
-
-% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
-% cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
-% might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
-% @node foo , bar , ...
-% We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
-%
-\parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
-%
-% also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
-% @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
-\def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
-\def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}\omittopnode}
-
-% Used so that the @top node doesn't have to be wrapped in an @ifnottex
-% conditional.
-% \doignore goes to more effort to skip nested conditionals but we don't need
-% that here.
-\def\omittopnode{%
- \ifx\lastnode\wordTop
- \expandafter\ignorenode\fi
-}
-\def\wordTop{Top}
-
-% Until the next @node or @bye command, divert output to a box that is not
-% output.
-\def\ignorenode{\setbox\dummybox\vbox\bgroup\def\node{\egroup\node}%
-\ignorenodebye
-}
-
-{\let\bye\relax
-\gdef\ignorenodebye{\let\bye\ignorenodebyedef}
-\gdef\ignorenodebyedef{\egroup(`Top' node ignored)\bye}}
-% The redefinition of \bye here is because it is declared \outer
-
-\let\lastnode=\empty
-
-% Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
-% type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
-%
-\def\donoderef#1{%
- \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
- \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
- \global\let\lastnode=\empty
- \fi
-}
-
-% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
-%
-\newcount\savesfregister
-%
-\def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
-\def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
-\def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
-
-% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
-% anchor), which consists of three parts:
-% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \currentsection,
-% or the anchor name.
-% 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
-% empty for anchors.
-% 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
-%
-% This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
-% floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
-% 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
-%
-\def\setref#1#2{%
- \pdfmkdest{#1}%
- \iflinks
- {%
- \requireauxfile
- \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
- % match definition in \xrdef, \refx, \xrefX.
- \def\value##1{##1}%
- \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
- \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
- ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
- }%
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\currentsection}%
- \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
- \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
- \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
- }%
- \fi
-}
-
-% @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
-% automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
-% This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
-% variable, now it's official.
-%
-\parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\onword
- \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
- = \empty
- \else\ifx\temp\offword
- \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
- = \relax
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp',
- must be on|off}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-%
-% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
-% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
-% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
-% manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
-%
-\def\pxref{\putwordsee{} \xrefXX}
-\def\xref{\putwordSee{} \xrefXX}
-\def\ref{\xrefXX}
-
-\def\xrefXX#1{\def\xrefXXarg{#1}\futurelet\tokenafterxref\xrefXXX}
-\def\xrefXXX{\expandafter\xrefX\expandafter[\xrefXXarg,,,,,,,]}
-%
-\newbox\toprefbox
-\newbox\printedrefnamebox
-\newbox\infofilenamebox
-\newbox\printedmanualbox
-%
-\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
- \unsepspaces
- %
- % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
- \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
- \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
- %
- \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
- \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
- %
- \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
- \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
- %
- % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
- % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
- \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
- % No printed node name was explicitly given.
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax
- % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
- \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
- \else
- % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
- % the square brackets if we have it.
- \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
- % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
- \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
- \else
- \ifhavexrefs
- % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
- \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
- \else
- % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
- \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
- \fi%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- %
- % Make link in pdf output.
- \ifpdf
- % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
- {\indexnofonts
- \makevalueexpandable
- \turnoffactive
- % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
- % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
- % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
- \getfilename{#4}%
- %
- % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
- % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
- \setpdfdestname{#1}%
- %
- \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
- \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
- \fi
- %
- \leavevmode
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
- \ifnum\filenamelength>0
- goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfdestname}%
- \else
- goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}%
- \fi
- }%
- \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
- \else
- \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
- \else
- % For XeTeX
- {\indexnofonts
- \makevalueexpandable
- \turnoffactive
- % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
- % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
- % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
- \getfilename{#4}%
- %
- % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
- % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
- \setpdfdestname{#1}%
- %
- \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
- \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
- \fi
- %
- \leavevmode
- \ifnum\filenamelength>0
- % With default settings,
- % XeTeX (xdvipdfmx) replaces link destination names with integers.
- % In this case, the replaced destination names of
- % remote PDFs are no longer known. In order to avoid a replacement,
- % you can use xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
- % If you use XeTeX 0.99996+ (TeX Live 2016+),
- % this command line option is no longer necessary
- % because we can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special.
- \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
- << /S /GoToR /F (\the\filename.pdf) /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
- \else
- \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
- << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
- \fi
- }%
- \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
- \fi
- \fi
- {%
- % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
- % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \def\value##1{##1}%
- \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
- \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
- }%
- %
- % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
- % instead of "[somenode], p.3". \iffloat distinguishes them by
- % \Xthisreftitle being set to a magic string.
- \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
- % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
- % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
- \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
- \refx{#1-snt}{}%
- \else
- \printedrefname
- \fi
- %
- % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
- % "in MANUALNAME".
- \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
- \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
- \fi
- \else
- % node/anchor (non-float) references.
- %
- % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
- % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
- % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
- % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
- % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
- % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
- %
- \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
- % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
- %
- \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
- %
- \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt
- % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
- % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as
- % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
- %
- \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
- %
- \else
- % Reference within this manual.
- %
- % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
- % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
- \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
- \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
- %
- % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
- \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
- %
- % But we always want a comma and a space:
- ,\space
- %
- % output the `page 3'.
- \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
- % Add a , if xref followed by a space
- \if\space\noexpand\tokenafterxref ,%
- \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,% @TAB
- \else\ifx\*\tokenafterxref ,% @*
- \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,% @SPACE
- \else\ifx\
- \tokenafterxref ,% @NL
- \else\ifx\tie\tokenafterxref ,% @tie
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
- \fi\fi
- \fi
- \endlink
-\endgroup}
-
-% Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice).
-%
-% Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
-% missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
-% "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
-%
-% But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
-% string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
-% the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
-% likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
-% in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
-%
-% For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
-% reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
-%
-\def\crossmanualxref#1{%
- \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}%
- \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
- \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp % nonempty?
- \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top?
- \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space
- \fi
- \fi
- #1%
-}
-
-% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
-% output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
-% since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
-% one that Bob is working on :).
-%
-\def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
-
-% Things referred to by \setref.
-%
-\def\Ynothing{}
-\def\Yomitfromtoc{}
-\def\Ynumbered{%
- \ifnum\secno=0
- \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
- \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
- \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
- \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
- \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
- \else
- \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
- \fi\fi\fi
-}
-\def\Yappendix{%
- \ifnum\secno=0
- \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
- \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
- \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
- \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
- \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
- \else
- \putwordSection@tie
- @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
- \fi\fi\fi
-}
-
-% \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} - reference a cross-reference string named NAME. SUFFIX
-% is output afterwards if non-empty.
-\def\refx#1#2{%
- \requireauxfile
- {%
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \def\value##1{##1}%
- \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
- \csname XR#1\endcsname
- }%
- \ifx\thisrefX\relax
- % If not defined, say something at least.
- \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
- \iflinks
- \ifhavexrefs
- {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
- \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}%
- \else
- \ifwarnedxrefs\else
- \global\warnedxrefstrue
- \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- \else
- % It's defined, so just use it.
- \thisrefX
- \fi
- #2% Output the suffix in any case.
-}
-
-% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Define a control
-% sequence for a cross-reference target (we prepend XR to the control sequence
-% name to avoid collisions). The value is the page number. If this is a float
-% type, we have more work to do.
-%
-\def\xrdef#1#2{%
- {% Expand the node or anchor name to remove control sequences.
- % \turnoffactive stops 8-bit characters being changed to commands
- % like @'e. \refx does the same to retrieve the value in the definition.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \def\value##1{##1}%
- \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
- }%
- %
- \bgroup
- \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}%
- \egroup
- % We put the \gdef inside a group to avoid the definitions building up on
- % TeX's save stack, which can cause it to run out of space for aux files with
- % thousands of lines. \gdef doesn't use the save stack, but \csname does
- % when it defines an unknown control sequence as \relax.
- %
- % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
- \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
- % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
- \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
- %
- % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
- \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
- \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
- \else
- % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
- \fi
- %
- % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
- % for later use in \listoffloats.
- \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
- {\safexrefname}}%
- \fi
-}
-
-% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
-% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
-% This is done with @novalidate at the beginning of the file.
-%
-\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
-\let\novalidate = \linksfalse
-
-% Used when writing to the aux file, or when using data from it.
-\def\requireauxfile{%
- \iflinks
- \tryauxfile
- % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
- \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
- \fi
- \global\let\requireauxfile=\relax % Only do this once.
-}
-
-% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
-%
-\def\tryauxfile{%
- \openin 1 \jobname.aux
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \readdatafile{aux}%
- \global\havexrefstrue
- \fi
- \closein 1
-}
-
-\def\setupdatafile{%
- \catcode`\^^@=\other
- \catcode`\^^A=\other
- \catcode`\^^B=\other
- \catcode`\^^C=\other
- \catcode`\^^D=\other
- \catcode`\^^E=\other
- \catcode`\^^F=\other
- \catcode`\^^G=\other
- \catcode`\^^H=\other
- \catcode`\^^K=\other
- \catcode`\^^L=\other
- \catcode`\^^N=\other
- \catcode`\^^P=\other
- \catcode`\^^Q=\other
- \catcode`\^^R=\other
- \catcode`\^^S=\other
- \catcode`\^^T=\other
- \catcode`\^^U=\other
- \catcode`\^^V=\other
- \catcode`\^^W=\other
- \catcode`\^^X=\other
- \catcode`\^^Z=\other
- \catcode`\^^[=\other
- \catcode`\^^\=\other
- \catcode`\^^]=\other
- \catcode`\^^^=\other
- \catcode`\^^_=\other
- \catcode`\^=\other
- %
- % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
- \catcode`\~=\other
- \catcode`\[=\other
- \catcode`\]=\other
- \catcode`\"=\other
- \catcode`\_=\other
- \catcode`\|=\other
- \catcode`\<=\other
- \catcode`\>=\other
- \catcode`\$=\other
- \catcode`\#=\other
- \catcode`\&=\other
- \catcode`\%=\other
- \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
- %
- \catcode`\\=\active
- %
- % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
- \catcode`\{=1
- \catcode`\}=2
- \catcode`\@=0
-}
-
-\def\readdatafile#1{%
-\begingroup
- \setupdatafile
- \input\jobname.#1
-\endgroup}
-
-
-\message{insertions,}
-% including footnotes.
-
-\newcount \footnoteno
-
-% The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
-% vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
-% pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
-% removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
-% space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
-\def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
-
-% @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
-\let\footnotestyle=\comment
-
-{\catcode `\@=11
-%
-% Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
-\gdef\footnote{%
- \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
- \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
- %
- % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
- % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
- \let\@sf\empty
- \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
- %
- % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
- \unskip
- \thisfootno\@sf
- \dofootnote
-}%
-
-% Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
-% footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
-%
-% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
-% \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
-% the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
-%
-\gdef\dofootnote{%
- \insert\footins\bgroup
- %
- % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
- % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
- \let\footnote=\errfootnotenest
- %
- % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
- % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
- % So reset some parameters.
- \hsize=\txipagewidth
- \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
- \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
- \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
- \floatingpenalty\@MM
- \leftskip\z@skip
- \rightskip\z@skip
- \spaceskip\z@skip
- \xspaceskip\z@skip
- \parindent\defaultparindent
- %
- \smallfonts \rm
- %
- % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
- % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
- % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
- % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
- \let\noindent = \relax
- %
- % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
- % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
- \everypar = {\hang}%
- \textindent{\thisfootno}%
- %
- % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
- % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
- % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
- \footstrut
- %
- % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
- \futurelet\next\fo@t
-}
-}%end \catcode `\@=11
-
-\def\errfootnotenest{%
- \errhelp=\EMsimple
- \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
- even though they work in makeinfo; sorry}
-}
-
-\def\errfootnoteheading{%
- \errhelp=\EMsimple
- \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported}
-}
-
-% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
-% the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
-% would be lost.
-% Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
-% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
-% And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
-%
-% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
-% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
-% out prematurely.
-%
-\def\startsavinginserts{%
- \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
- \let\insert\saveinsert
- \else
- \let\checkinserts\relax
- \fi
-}
-
-% This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
-% \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
-%
-\def\saveinsert#1{%
- \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
- \afterassignment\next
- % swallow the left brace
- \let\temp =
-}
-\def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
-\def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
-
-\def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
-
-\def\placesaveins#1{%
- \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
- {\box#1}%
-}
-
-% eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
-{
- \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
- \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
-}
-
-% initialization:
-\def\newsaveins #1{%
- \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
- \next
-}
-\def\newsaveinsX #1{%
- \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
- \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
- \checksaveins #1}%
-}
-
-% initialize:
-\let\checkinserts\empty
-\newsaveins\footins
-\newsaveins\margin
-
-
-% @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
-% If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
-%
-% Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
-% time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
-% undone and the next image would fail.
-\openin 1 = epsf.tex
-\ifeof 1 \else
- % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
- % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
- \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
- \input epsf.tex
-\fi
-\closein 1
-%
-% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
-\newif\ifwarnednoepsf
-\newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
- work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
- it from https://ctan.org/texarchive/macros/texinfo/texinfo/doc/epsf.tex.}
-%
-\def\image#1{%
- \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
- \ifwarnednoepsf \else
- \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
- \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
- \global\warnednoepsftrue
- \fi
- \else
- \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
- \fi
-}
-%
-% Arguments to @image:
-% #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
-% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
-% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
-% #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
-% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
-\newif\ifimagevmode
-\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
- \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
- \def\xprocessmacroarg{\eatspaces}% in case we are being used via a macro
- % If the image is by itself, center it.
- \ifvmode
- \imagevmodetrue
- \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
- % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
- \imagevmodetrue
- \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
- \fi\fi
- %
- \ifimagevmode
- \nobreak\medskip
- % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
- % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
- % above and below.
- \nobreak\vskip\parskip
- \nobreak
- \fi
- %
- % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
- % environment such as @quotation is respected.
- % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
- % normal paragraph indentation.
- % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
- % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
- % eradicate the centering.
- \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
- %
- % Output the image.
- \ifpdf
- % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX <= 0.80
- \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
- \else
- \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
- % For epsf.tex
- % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
- \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
- \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
- \else
- % For XeTeX
- \doxeteximage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
- \fi
- \fi
- %
- \ifimagevmode
- \medskip % space after a standalone image
- \fi
- \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
-\endgroup}
-
-
-% @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
-% etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
-% float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
-%
-\envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
-
-% There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
-\def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
-
-% #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
-% "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
-% this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
-%
-% #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
-% be referable.
-%
-% #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
-% will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
-%
-% We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
-% chapter-level command.
-\let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
-%
-\def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
- \let\thiscaption=\empty
- \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
- %
- % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
- %
- % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
- % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
- %
- \startsavinginserts
- %
- % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
- \par
- %
- \vtop\bgroup
- \def\floattype{#1}%
- \def\floatlabel{#2}%
- \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
- %
- \ifx\floattype\empty
- \let\safefloattype=\empty
- \else
- {%
- % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
- % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
- }%
- \fi
- %
- % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
- \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
- % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
- % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
- %
- \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
- \global\advance\floatno by 1
- %
- {%
- % This magic value for \currentsection is output by \setref as the
- % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
- % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
- % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
- % lists of floats.
- %
- \edef\currentsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
- \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
- }%
- \fi
- %
- % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
- \vskip\parskip
- %
- % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
- \restorefirstparagraphindent
-}
-
-% we have these possibilities:
-% @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
-% @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
-% @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
-% @float Foo & no caption: Foo
-% @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
-% @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
-% @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
-% @float & no caption:
-%
-\def\Efloat{%
- \let\floatident = \empty
- %
- % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
- \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
- %
- % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
- \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
- \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
- \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
- \fi
- % the number.
- \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
- \fi
- %
- % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
- % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
- \let\captionline = \floatident
- %
- \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
- \ifx\floatident\empty \else
- \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
- \fi
- %
- % caption text.
- \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
- \fi
- %
- % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
- % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
- \ifx\captionline\empty \else
- \vskip.5\parskip
- \captionline
- %
- % Space below caption.
- \vskip\parskip
- \fi
- %
- % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
- % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
- \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
- % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
- % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
- % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
- {%
- \requireauxfile
- \atdummies
- %
- \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
- \def\gtemp{\thiscaption}%
- \else
- \def\gtemp{\thisshortcaption}%
- \fi
- \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
- \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
- }%
- \fi
- \egroup % end of \vtop
- %
- \checkinserts
-}
-
-% Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
-%
-\def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
- \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
-}
-
-% @caption, @shortcaption
-%
-\def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
-\def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
-\def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
-\def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
-
-% The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
-% going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
-\def\getfloatno#1{%
- \ifx#1\relax
- % Haven't seen this figure type before.
- \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
- %
- % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
- \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
- \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
- \fi
- \let\floatno#1%
-}
-
-% \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
-% to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
-% first read the @float command.
-%
-\def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
-
-% Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
-% distinguish floats from other xref types.
-\def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
-
-% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
-% which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
-% \currentsection value which we \setref above.
-%
-\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
-%
-% #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
-% (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
-%
-\def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \def\iffloattype{#2}%
- \ifx\temp\floatmagic
-}
-
-% @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
-%
-\parseargdef\listoffloats{%
- \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
- {%
- % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
- % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
- }%
- %
- % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
- \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
- \ifhavexrefs
- % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
- \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
- \fi
- \else
- \begingroup
- \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
- \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
- \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
- \endgroup
- \fi
-}
-
-% This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
-% xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
-% aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
-% has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
-%
-% Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
-% they won't appear in the aux file).
-%
-\def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
-\def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
- % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
- % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
- % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
- % in pdf output.
- \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
- %
- % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
- \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
- \writeentry
-}}
-
-
-\message{localization,}
-
-% For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
-% early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
-% (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
-%
-{
- \catcode`\_ = \active
- \globaldefs=1
-\parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
- \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
- % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
- \let_ = \normalunderscore % normal _ character for filename test
- \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
- \ifeof 1
- \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_\finish
- \else
- \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
- \input txi-#1.tex
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \endgroup % end raw TeX
-}
-%
-% If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
-% try txi-de.tex.
-%
-\gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
- \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
- \ifeof 1
- \errhelp = \nolanghelp
- \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
- \else
- \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
- \input txi-#1.tex
- \fi
- \closein 1
-}
-}% end of special _ catcode
-%
-\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
-is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
-directory should work if nowhere else does.}
-
-% This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
-% \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
-% third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
-%
-% The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
-% See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
-% /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
-%
-% With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
-% available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
-% Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
-% accented characters problem.)
-%
-\catcode`@=11
-\def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
- % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
- \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
- \message{no patterns for #1}%
- \else
- \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
- \fi
- % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
- \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
- \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
-}
-
-% XeTeX and LuaTeX can handle Unicode natively.
-% Their default I/O uses UTF-8 sequences instead of a byte-wise operation.
-% Other TeX engines' I/O (pdfTeX, etc.) is byte-wise.
-%
-\newif\iftxinativeunicodecapable
-\newif\iftxiusebytewiseio
-
-\ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
- \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
- \txinativeunicodecapablefalse
- \txiusebytewiseiotrue
- \else
- \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
- \txiusebytewiseiofalse
- \fi
-\else
- \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
- \txiusebytewiseiofalse
-\fi
-
-% Set I/O by bytes instead of UTF-8 sequence for XeTeX and LuaTex
-% for non-UTF-8 (byte-wise) encodings.
-%
-\def\setbytewiseio{%
- \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
- \else
- \XeTeXdefaultencoding "bytes" % For subsequent files to be read
- \XeTeXinputencoding "bytes" % For document root file
- % Unfortunately, there seems to be no corresponding XeTeX command for
- % output encoding. This is a problem for auxiliary index and TOC files.
- % The only solution would be perhaps to write out @U{...} sequences in
- % place of non-ASCII characters.
- \fi
-
- \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
- \else
- \directlua{
- local utf8_char, byte, gsub = unicode.utf8.char, string.byte, string.gsub
- local function convert_char (char)
- return utf8_char(byte(char))
- end
-
- local function convert_line (line)
- return gsub(line, ".", convert_char)
- end
-
- callback.register("process_input_buffer", convert_line)
-
- local function convert_line_out (line)
- local line_out = ""
- for c in string.utfvalues(line) do
- line_out = line_out .. string.char(c)
- end
- return line_out
- end
-
- callback.register("process_output_buffer", convert_line_out)
- }
- \fi
-
- \txiusebytewiseiotrue
-}
-
-
-% Helpers for encodings.
-% Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
-%
-\def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
- \count255=128
- \loop\ifnum\count255<256
- \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
- \advance\count255 by 1
- \repeat
-}
-
-\def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
- \count255=128
- \loop\ifnum\count255<256
- \catcode\count255=#1\relax
- \advance\count255 by 1
- \repeat
-}
-
-% @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
-% according to the specified encoding.
-%
-\def\documentencoding{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\documentencodingzzz}
-\def\documentencodingzzz#1{%
- %
- % Encoding being declared for the document.
- \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
- %
- % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
- % to compare them with \ifx.
- \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
- \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
- \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
- \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
- \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
- %
- \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
- \asciichardefs
- %
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
- \iftxinativeunicodecapable
- \setbytewiseio
- \fi
- \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- \lattwochardefs
- %
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
- \iftxinativeunicodecapable
- \setbytewiseio
- \fi
- \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- \latonechardefs
- %
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
- \iftxinativeunicodecapable
- \setbytewiseio
- \fi
- \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- \latninechardefs
- %
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
- \iftxinativeunicodecapable
- % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX)
- \nativeunicodechardefs
- \else
- % For treating UTF-8 as byte sequences (TeX, eTeX and pdfTeX)
- \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- % since we already invoked \utfeightchardefs at the top level
- % (below), do not re-invoke it, otherwise our check for duplicated
- % definitions gets triggered. Making non-ascii chars active is
- % sufficient.
- \fi
- %
- \else
- \message{Ignoring unknown document encoding: #1.}%
- %
- \fi % utfeight
- \fi % latnine
- \fi % latone
- \fi % lattwo
- \fi % ascii
- %
- \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
- \else
- \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
- \else
- \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
- \else
- \message{Warning: XeTeX with non-UTF-8 encodings cannot handle %
- non-ASCII characters in auxiliary files.}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
-}
-
-% emacs-page
-% A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
-% the default font encoding (OT1).
-%
-\def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing, sorry: #1.}}
-
-% Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
-\def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
-
-% First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
-% correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
-% macros containing the character definitions.
-\setnonasciicharscatcode\active
-%
-
-\def\gdefchar#1#2{%
-\gdef#1{%
- \ifpassthroughchars
- \string#1%
- \else
- #2%
- \fi
-}}
-
-% Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
-\def\latonechardefs{%
- \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
- \gdefchar^^a1{\exclamdown}
- \gdefchar^^a2{{\tcfont \char162}} % cent
- \gdefchar^^a3{\pounds{}}
- \gdefchar^^a4{{\tcfont \char164}} % currency
- \gdefchar^^a5{{\tcfont \char165}} % yen
- \gdefchar^^a6{{\tcfont \char166}} % broken bar
- \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
- \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
- \gdefchar^^a9{\copyright{}}
- \gdefchar^^aa{\ordf}
- \gdefchar^^ab{\guillemetleft{}}
- \gdefchar^^ac{\ensuremath\lnot}
- \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
- \gdefchar^^ae{\registeredsymbol{}}
- \gdefchar^^af{\={}}
- %
- \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree}
- \gdefchar^^b1{$\pm$}
- \gdefchar^^b2{$^2$}
- \gdefchar^^b3{$^3$}
- \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
- \gdefchar^^b5{$\mu$}
- \gdefchar^^b6{\P}
- \gdefchar^^b7{\ensuremath\cdot}
- \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
- \gdefchar^^b9{$^1$}
- \gdefchar^^ba{\ordm}
- \gdefchar^^bb{\guillemetright{}}
- \gdefchar^^bc{$1\over4$}
- \gdefchar^^bd{$1\over2$}
- \gdefchar^^be{$3\over4$}
- \gdefchar^^bf{\questiondown}
- %
- \gdefchar^^c0{\`A}
- \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
- \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
- \gdefchar^^c3{\~A}
- \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
- \gdefchar^^c5{\ringaccent A}
- \gdefchar^^c6{\AE}
- \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
- \gdefchar^^c8{\`E}
- \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
- \gdefchar^^ca{\^E}
- \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
- \gdefchar^^cc{\`I}
- \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
- \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
- \gdefchar^^cf{\"I}
- %
- \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
- \gdefchar^^d1{\~N}
- \gdefchar^^d2{\`O}
- \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
- \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
- \gdefchar^^d5{\~O}
- \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
- \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
- \gdefchar^^d8{\O}
- \gdefchar^^d9{\`U}
- \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
- \gdefchar^^db{\^U}
- \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
- \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
- \gdefchar^^de{\TH}
- \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
- %
- \gdefchar^^e0{\`a}
- \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
- \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
- \gdefchar^^e3{\~a}
- \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
- \gdefchar^^e5{\ringaccent a}
- \gdefchar^^e6{\ae}
- \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
- \gdefchar^^e8{\`e}
- \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
- \gdefchar^^ea{\^e}
- \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
- \gdefchar^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
- \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
- \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
- \gdefchar^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
- %
- \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
- \gdefchar^^f1{\~n}
- \gdefchar^^f2{\`o}
- \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
- \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
- \gdefchar^^f5{\~o}
- \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
- \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
- \gdefchar^^f8{\o}
- \gdefchar^^f9{\`u}
- \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
- \gdefchar^^fb{\^u}
- \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
- \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
- \gdefchar^^fe{\th}
- \gdefchar^^ff{\"y}
-}
-
-% Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
-\def\latninechardefs{%
- % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
- \latonechardefs
- %
- \gdefchar^^a4{\euro{}}
- \gdefchar^^a6{\v S}
- \gdefchar^^a8{\v s}
- \gdefchar^^b4{\v Z}
- \gdefchar^^b8{\v z}
- \gdefchar^^bc{\OE}
- \gdefchar^^bd{\oe}
- \gdefchar^^be{\"Y}
-}
-
-% Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
-\def\lattwochardefs{%
- \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
- \gdefchar^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
- \gdefchar^^a2{\u{}}
- \gdefchar^^a3{\L}
- \gdefchar^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
- \gdefchar^^a5{\v L}
- \gdefchar^^a6{\'S}
- \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
- \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
- \gdefchar^^a9{\v S}
- \gdefchar^^aa{\cedilla S}
- \gdefchar^^ab{\v T}
- \gdefchar^^ac{\'Z}
- \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
- \gdefchar^^ae{\v Z}
- \gdefchar^^af{\dotaccent Z}
- %
- \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree{}}
- \gdefchar^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
- \gdefchar^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
- \gdefchar^^b3{\l}
- \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
- \gdefchar^^b5{\v l}
- \gdefchar^^b6{\'s}
- \gdefchar^^b7{\v{}}
- \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
- \gdefchar^^b9{\v s}
- \gdefchar^^ba{\cedilla s}
- \gdefchar^^bb{\v t}
- \gdefchar^^bc{\'z}
- \gdefchar^^bd{\H{}}
- \gdefchar^^be{\v z}
- \gdefchar^^bf{\dotaccent z}
- %
- \gdefchar^^c0{\'R}
- \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
- \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
- \gdefchar^^c3{\u A}
- \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
- \gdefchar^^c5{\'L}
- \gdefchar^^c6{\'C}
- \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
- \gdefchar^^c8{\v C}
- \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
- \gdefchar^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
- \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
- \gdefchar^^cc{\v E}
- \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
- \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
- \gdefchar^^cf{\v D}
- %
- \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
- \gdefchar^^d1{\'N}
- \gdefchar^^d2{\v N}
- \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
- \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
- \gdefchar^^d5{\H O}
- \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
- \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
- \gdefchar^^d8{\v R}
- \gdefchar^^d9{\ringaccent U}
- \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
- \gdefchar^^db{\H U}
- \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
- \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
- \gdefchar^^de{\cedilla T}
- \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
- %
- \gdefchar^^e0{\'r}
- \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
- \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
- \gdefchar^^e3{\u a}
- \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
- \gdefchar^^e5{\'l}
- \gdefchar^^e6{\'c}
- \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
- \gdefchar^^e8{\v c}
- \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
- \gdefchar^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
- \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
- \gdefchar^^ec{\v e}
- \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}}
- \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}}
- \gdefchar^^ef{\v d}
- %
- \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
- \gdefchar^^f1{\'n}
- \gdefchar^^f2{\v n}
- \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
- \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
- \gdefchar^^f5{\H o}
- \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
- \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
- \gdefchar^^f8{\v r}
- \gdefchar^^f9{\ringaccent u}
- \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
- \gdefchar^^fb{\H u}
- \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
- \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
- \gdefchar^^fe{\cedilla t}
- \gdefchar^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
-}
-
-% UTF-8 character definitions.
-%
-% This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
-% changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
-% permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
-%
-\newcount\countUTFx
-\newcount\countUTFy
-\newcount\countUTFz
-
-\gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
- \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
-%
-\gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
- \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
-%
-\gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
- \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
-
-\gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
- \ifx #1\relax
- \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
- \else
- \expandafter #1%
- \fi
-}
-
-% Give non-ASCII bytes the active definitions for processing UTF-8 sequences
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\~13
- \catcode`\$12
- \catcode`\"12
-
- % Loop from \countUTFx to \countUTFy, performing \UTFviiiTmp
- % substituting ~ and $ with a character token of that value.
- \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
- \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
- \uccode`\~\countUTFx
- \uccode`\$\countUTFx
- \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
- \advance\countUTFx by 1
- \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
- \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
- \fi}
-
- % For bytes other than the first in a UTF-8 sequence. Not expected to
- % be expanded except when writing to auxiliary files.
- \countUTFx = "80
- \countUTFy = "C2
- \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
- \gdef~{%
- \ifpassthroughchars $\fi}}%
- \UTFviiiLoop
-
- \countUTFx = "C2
- \countUTFy = "E0
- \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
- \gdef~{%
- \ifpassthroughchars $%
- \else\expandafter\UTFviiiTwoOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
- \UTFviiiLoop
-
- \countUTFx = "E0
- \countUTFy = "F0
- \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
- \gdef~{%
- \ifpassthroughchars $%
- \else\expandafter\UTFviiiThreeOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
- \UTFviiiLoop
-
- \countUTFx = "F0
- \countUTFy = "F4
- \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
- \gdef~{%
- \ifpassthroughchars $%
- \else\expandafter\UTFviiiFourOctets\expandafter$\fi
- }}%
- \UTFviiiLoop
-\endgroup
-
-\def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below
-
-% @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it.
-\def\U#1{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax
- \iftxinativeunicodecapable
- % All Unicode characters can be used if native Unicode handling is
- % active. However, if the font does not have the glyph,
- % letters are missing.
- \begingroup
- \uccode`\.="#1\relax
- \uppercase{.}
- \endgroup
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unicode character U+#1 not supported, sorry}%
- \fi
- \else
- \csname uni:#1\endcsname
- \fi
-}
-
-% These macros are used here to construct the name of a control
-% sequence to be defined.
-\def\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName#1#2{%
- \csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}%
-\def\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName#1#2#3{%
- \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}%
-\def\UTFviiiFourOctetsName#1#2#3#4{%
- \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}%
-
-% For UTF-8 byte sequences (TeX, e-TeX and pdfTeX),
-% provide a definition macro to replace a Unicode character;
-% this gets used by the @U command
-%
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\"=12
- \catcode`\<=12
- \catcode`\.=12
- \catcode`\,=12
- \catcode`\;=12
- \catcode`\!=12
- \catcode`\~=13
- \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii#1#2{%
- \countUTFz = "#1\relax
- \begingroup
- \parseXMLCharref
-
- % Give \u8:... its definition. The sequence of seven \expandafter's
- % expands after the \gdef three times, e.g.
- %
- % 1. \UTFviiTwoOctetsName B1 B2
- % 2. \csname u8:B1 \string B2 \endcsname
- % 3. \u8: B1 B2 (a single control sequence token)
- %
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\gdef \UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
- %
- \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax \else
- \message{Internal error, already defined: #1}%
- \fi
- %
- % define an additional control sequence for this code point.
- \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp
- \endgroup}
- %
- % Given the value in \countUTFz as a Unicode code point, set \UTFviiiTmp
- % to the corresponding UTF-8 sequence.
- \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
- \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
- \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
- \parseUTFviiiA,%
- \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName.,%
- \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
- \parseUTFviiiA;%
- \parseUTFviiiA,%
- \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName.{,;}%
- \else
- \parseUTFviiiA;%
- \parseUTFviiiA,%
- \parseUTFviiiA!%
- \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctetsName.{!,;}%
- \fi\fi\fi
- }
-
- % Extract a byte from the end of the UTF-8 representation of \countUTFx.
- % It must be a non-initial byte in the sequence.
- % Change \uccode of #1 for it to be used in \parseUTFviiiB as one
- % of the bytes.
- \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
- \countUTFx = \countUTFz
- \divide\countUTFz by 64
- \countUTFy = \countUTFz % Save to be the future value of \countUTFz.
- \multiply\countUTFz by 64
-
- % \countUTFz is now \countUTFx with the last 5 bits cleared. Subtract
- % in order to get the last five bits.
- \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
-
- % Convert this to the byte in the UTF-8 sequence.
- \advance\countUTFx by 128
- \uccode `#1\countUTFx
- \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
-
- % Used to put a UTF-8 byte sequence into \UTFviiiTmp
- % #1 is the increment for \countUTFz to yield a the first byte of the UTF-8
- % sequence.
- % #2 is one of the \UTFviii*OctetsName macros.
- % #3 is always a full stop (.)
- % #4 is a template for the other bytes in the sequence. The values for these
- % bytes is substituted in here with \uppercase using the \uccode's.
- \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
- \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
- \uccode `#3\countUTFz
- \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
-\endgroup
-
-% For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
-% provide a definition macro that sets a catcode to `other' non-globally
-%
-\def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeOther#1#2{%
- \catcode"#1=\other
-}
-
-% https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Plane_(Unicode)#Basic_M
-% U+0000..U+007F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Basic_Latin_(Unicode_block)
-% U+0080..U+00FF = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin-1_Supplement_(Unicode_block)
-% U+0100..U+017F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-A
-% U+0180..U+024F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-B
-%
-% Many of our renditions are less than wonderful, and all the missing
-% characters are available somewhere. Loading the necessary fonts
-% awaits user request. We can't truly support Unicode without
-% reimplementing everything that's been done in LaTeX for many years,
-% plus probably using luatex or xetex, and who knows what else.
-% We won't be doing that here in this simple file. But we can try to at
-% least make most of the characters not bomb out.
-%
-\def\unicodechardefs{%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A2}{{\tcfont \char162}}% 0242=cent
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A4}{{\tcfont \char164}}% 0244=currency
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A5}{{\tcfont \char165}}% 0245=yen
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A6}{{\tcfont \char166}}% 0246=brokenbar
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A7}{\S}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AC}{\ensuremath\lnot}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B1}{\ensuremath\pm}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B2}{$^2$}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B3}{$^3$}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B5}{$\mu$}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B6}{\P}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B7}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B9}{$^1$}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BC}{$1\over4$}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BD}{$1\over2$}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BE}{$3\over4$}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D7}{\ensuremath\times}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F7}{\ensuremath\div}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010F}{d'}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0110}{\DH}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0111}{\dh}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0122}{\cedilla{G}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0123}{\cedilla{g}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0126}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0127}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012E}{\ogonek{I}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012F}{\ogonek{i}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0136}{\cedilla{K}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0137}{\cedilla{k}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0138}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013B}{\cedilla{L}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013C}{\cedilla{l}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013D}{L'}% should kern
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013E}{l'}% should kern
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013F}{L\U{00B7}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0140}{l\U{00B7}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0145}{\cedilla{N}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0146}{\cedilla{n}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0149}{'n}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014A}{\missingcharmsg{ENG}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014B}{\missingcharmsg{eng}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0156}{\cedilla{R}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0157}{\cedilla{r}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{T}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{t}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0165}{\v{t}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0166}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0167}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0172}{\ogonek{U}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0173}{\ogonek{u}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017F}{\missingcharmsg{LONG S}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02BC}{'}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}%
- %
- % Greek letters upper case
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0391}{{\it A}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0392}{{\it B}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0393}{\ensuremath{\mit\Gamma}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0394}{\ensuremath{\mit\Delta}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0395}{{\it E}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0396}{{\it Z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0397}{{\it H}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0398}{\ensuremath{\mit\Theta}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0399}{{\it I}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039A}{{\it K}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039B}{\ensuremath{\mit\Lambda}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039C}{{\it M}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039D}{{\it N}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039E}{\ensuremath{\mit\Xi}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039F}{{\it O}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A0}{\ensuremath{\mit\Pi}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A1}{{\it P}}%
- %\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A2}{} % none - corresponds to final sigma
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A3}{\ensuremath{\mit\Sigma}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A4}{{\it T}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A5}{\ensuremath{\mit\Upsilon}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A6}{\ensuremath{\mit\Phi}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A7}{{\it X}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A8}{\ensuremath{\mit\Psi}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A9}{\ensuremath{\mit\Omega}}%
- %
- % Vowels with accents
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0390}{\ensuremath{\ddot{\acute\iota}}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AC}{\ensuremath{\acute\alpha}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AD}{\ensuremath{\acute\epsilon}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AE}{\ensuremath{\acute\eta}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AF}{\ensuremath{\acute\iota}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B0}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ddot\upsilon}}}%
- %
- % Standalone accent
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0384}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ }}}%
- %
- % Greek letters lower case
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B1}{\ensuremath\alpha}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B2}{\ensuremath\beta}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B3}{\ensuremath\gamma}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B4}{\ensuremath\delta}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B5}{\ensuremath\epsilon}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B6}{\ensuremath\zeta}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B7}{\ensuremath\eta}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B8}{\ensuremath\theta}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B9}{\ensuremath\iota}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BA}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BB}{\ensuremath\lambda}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BC}{\ensuremath\mu}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BD}{\ensuremath\nu}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BE}{\ensuremath\xi}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BF}{{\it o}}% omicron
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C0}{\ensuremath\pi}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C1}{\ensuremath\rho}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C2}{\ensuremath\varsigma}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C3}{\ensuremath\sigma}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C4}{\ensuremath\tau}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C5}{\ensuremath\upsilon}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C6}{\ensuremath\phi}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C7}{\ensuremath\chi}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C8}{\ensuremath\psi}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C9}{\ensuremath\omega}%
- %
- % More Greek vowels with accents
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CA}{\ensuremath{\ddot\iota}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CB}{\ensuremath{\ddot\upsilon}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CC}{\ensuremath{\acute o}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CD}{\ensuremath{\acute\upsilon}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CE}{\ensuremath{\acute\omega}}%
- %
- % Variant Greek letters
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D1}{\ensuremath\vartheta}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D6}{\ensuremath\varpi}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03F1}{\ensuremath\varrho}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}%
- %
- % Punctuation
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2020}{\ensuremath\dagger}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2021}{\ensuremath\ddagger}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{202F}{\thinspace}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright{}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro{}}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result{}}%
- %
- % Mathematical symbols
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2200}{\ensuremath\forall}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2203}{\ensuremath\exists}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2208}{\ensuremath\in}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\ast}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221E}{\ensuremath\infty}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2225}{\ensuremath\parallel}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2227}{\ensuremath\wedge}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2229}{\ensuremath\cap}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv{}}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2264}{\ensuremath\leq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2265}{\ensuremath\geq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2282}{\ensuremath\subset}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2287}{\ensuremath\supseteq}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2016}{\ensuremath\Vert}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2032}{\ensuremath\prime}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{210F}{\ensuremath\hbar}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2111}{\ensuremath\Im}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2113}{\ensuremath\ell}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2118}{\ensuremath\wp}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{211C}{\ensuremath\Re}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2135}{\ensuremath\aleph}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2190}{\ensuremath\leftarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2191}{\ensuremath\uparrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2193}{\ensuremath\downarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2194}{\ensuremath\leftrightarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2195}{\ensuremath\updownarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2196}{\ensuremath\nwarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2197}{\ensuremath\nearrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2198}{\ensuremath\searrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2199}{\ensuremath\swarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A6}{\ensuremath\mapsto}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A9}{\ensuremath\hookleftarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21AA}{\ensuremath\hookrightarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BC}{\ensuremath\leftharpoonup}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BD}{\ensuremath\leftharpoondown}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C0}{\ensuremath\rightharpoonup}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C1}{\ensuremath\rightharpoondown}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21CC}{\ensuremath\rightleftharpoons}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D0}{\ensuremath\Leftarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D1}{\ensuremath\Uparrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D3}{\ensuremath\Downarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D4}{\ensuremath\Leftrightarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D5}{\ensuremath\Updownarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2202}{\ensuremath\partial}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2205}{\ensuremath\emptyset}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2207}{\ensuremath\nabla}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2209}{\ensuremath\notin}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220B}{\ensuremath\owns}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220F}{\ensuremath\prod}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2210}{\ensuremath\coprod}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2211}{\ensuremath\sum}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2213}{\ensuremath\mp}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2218}{\ensuremath\circ}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221A}{\ensuremath\surd}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221D}{\ensuremath\propto}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2220}{\ensuremath\angle}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2223}{\ensuremath\mid}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2228}{\ensuremath\vee}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222A}{\ensuremath\cup}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222B}{\ensuremath\smallint}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222E}{\ensuremath\oint}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{223C}{\ensuremath\sim}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2240}{\ensuremath\wr}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2243}{\ensuremath\simeq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2245}{\ensuremath\cong}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2248}{\ensuremath\approx}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{224D}{\ensuremath\asymp}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2250}{\ensuremath\doteq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2260}{\ensuremath\neq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226A}{\ensuremath\ll}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226B}{\ensuremath\gg}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227A}{\ensuremath\prec}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227B}{\ensuremath\succ}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2283}{\ensuremath\supset}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2286}{\ensuremath\subseteq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228E}{\ensuremath\uplus}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2291}{\ensuremath\sqsubseteq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2292}{\ensuremath\sqsupseteq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2293}{\ensuremath\sqcap}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2294}{\ensuremath\sqcup}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2295}{\ensuremath\oplus}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2296}{\ensuremath\ominus}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2297}{\ensuremath\otimes}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2298}{\ensuremath\oslash}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2299}{\ensuremath\odot}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A2}{\ensuremath\vdash}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A3}{\ensuremath\dashv}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A4}{\ensuremath\ptextop}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A5}{\ensuremath\bot}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A8}{\ensuremath\models}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C0}{\ensuremath\bigwedge}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C1}{\ensuremath\bigvee}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C2}{\ensuremath\bigcap}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C3}{\ensuremath\bigcup}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C4}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C5}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C6}{\ensuremath\star}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C8}{\ensuremath\bowtie}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2308}{\ensuremath\lceil}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2309}{\ensuremath\rceil}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230A}{\ensuremath\lfloor}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230B}{\ensuremath\rfloor}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2322}{\ensuremath\frown}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2323}{\ensuremath\smile}%
- %
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B3}{\ensuremath\triangle}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B7}{\ensuremath\triangleright}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25BD}{\ensuremath\bigtriangledown}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C1}{\ensuremath\triangleleft}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C7}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2660}{\ensuremath\spadesuit}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2661}{\ensuremath\heartsuit}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2662}{\ensuremath\diamondsuit}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2663}{\ensuremath\clubsuit}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266D}{\ensuremath\flat}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266E}{\ensuremath\natural}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266F}{\ensuremath\sharp}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{26AA}{\ensuremath\bigcirc}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27B9}{\ensuremath\rangle}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27C2}{\ensuremath\perp}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27E8}{\ensuremath\langle}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F5}{\ensuremath\longleftarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F6}{\ensuremath\longrightarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F7}{\ensuremath\longleftrightarrow}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27FC}{\ensuremath\longmapsto}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{29F5}{\ensuremath\setminus}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A00}{\ensuremath\bigodot}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A01}{\ensuremath\bigoplus}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A02}{\ensuremath\bigotimes}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A04}{\ensuremath\biguplus}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A06}{\ensuremath\bigsqcup}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A3F}{\ensuremath\amalg}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AAF}{\ensuremath\preceq}%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AB0}{\ensuremath\succeq}%
- %
- \global\mathchardef\checkmark="1370% actually the square root sign
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2713}{\ensuremath\checkmark}%
-}% end of \unicodechardefs
-
-% UTF-8 byte sequence (pdfTeX) definitions (replacing and @U command)
-% It makes the setting that replace UTF-8 byte sequence.
-\def\utfeightchardefs{%
- \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii
- \unicodechardefs
-}
-
-% Whether the active definitions of non-ASCII characters expand to
-% non-active tokens with the same character code. This is used to
-% write characters literally, instead of using active definitions for
-% printing the correct glyphs.
-\newif\ifpassthroughchars
-\passthroughcharsfalse
-
-% For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
-% provide a definition macro to replace/pass-through a Unicode character
-%
-\def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative#1#2{%
- \catcode"#1=\active
- \def\dodeclareunicodecharacternative##1##2##3{%
- \begingroup
- \uccode`\~="##2\relax
- \uppercase{\gdef~}{%
- \ifpassthroughchars
- ##1%
- \else
- ##3%
- \fi
- }
- \endgroup
- }
- \begingroup
- \uccode`\.="#1\relax
- \uppercase{\def\UTFNativeTmp{.}}%
- \expandafter\dodeclareunicodecharacternative\UTFNativeTmp{#1}{#2}%
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% Native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX) character replacing definition.
-% It activates the setting that replaces Unicode characters.
-\def\nativeunicodechardefs{%
- \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative
- \unicodechardefs
-}
-
-% For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
-% make the character token expand
-% to the sequences given in \unicodechardefs for printing.
-\def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU#1#2{%
- \def\UTFAtUTmp{#2}
- \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFAtUTmp
-}
-
-% @U command definitions for native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX).
-\def\nativeunicodechardefsatu{%
- \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU
- \unicodechardefs
-}
-
-% US-ASCII character definitions.
-\def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
- \relax
-}
-
-% Define all Unicode characters we know about. This makes UTF-8 the default
-% input encoding and allows @U to work.
-\iftxinativeunicodecapable
- \nativeunicodechardefsatu
-\else
- \utfeightchardefs
-\fi
-
-\message{formatting,}
-
-\newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
-
-\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
-\secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
-\subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
-
-% Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
-\vbadness = 10000
-
-% Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
-\hbadness = 6666
-
-% Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
-\widowpenalty=10000
-\clubpenalty=10000
-
-% Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
-% using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
-% stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
-% \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
-%
-\def\setemergencystretch{%
- \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
- % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
- \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
- \else
- \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
- \fi
-}
-
-% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
-% 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
-% 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
-%
-% We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
-% \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
-%
-\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
- \voffset = #3\relax
- \topskip = #6\relax
- \splittopskip = \topskip
- %
- \vsize = #1\relax
- \advance\vsize by \topskip
- \outervsize = \vsize
- \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
- \txipageheight = \vsize
- %
- \hsize = #2\relax
- \outerhsize = \hsize
- \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
- \txipagewidth = \hsize
- %
- \normaloffset = #4\relax
- \bindingoffset = #5\relax
- %
- \ifpdf
- \pdfpageheight #7\relax
- \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
- % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
- % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
- \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
- \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
- \else
- \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
- \special{papersize=#8,#7}%
- \else
- \pdfpageheight #7\relax
- \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
- % XeTeX does not have \pdfhorigin and \pdfvorigin.
- \fi
- \fi
- %
- \setleading{\textleading}
- %
- \parindent = \defaultparindent
- \setemergencystretch
-}
-
-% @letterpaper (the default).
-\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- \textleading = 13.2pt
- %
- % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
- \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
- {\voffset}{.25in}%
- {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
- {11in}{8.5in}%
-}}
-
-% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
-\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
- \textleading = 12pt
- %
- \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
- {-.2in}{0in}%
- {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
- {9.25in}{7in}%
- %
- \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
- \tolerance = 700
- \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \defbodyindent = .5cm
-}}
-
-% Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
-% (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
-\def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
- \textleading = 12pt
- %
- \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
- {-.2in}{-.4in}%
- {0pt}{14pt}%
- {9in}{6in}%
- %
- \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
- \tolerance = 700
- \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \defbodyindent = .4cm
-}}
-
-% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
-\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- \textleading = 13.2pt
- %
- % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
- % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
- % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
- % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
- % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
- % your texinfo source file like this:
- % @tex
- % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
- % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
- % @end tex
- \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
- {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
- {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
- {297mm}{210mm}%
- %
- \tolerance = 700
- \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \defbodyindent = 5mm
-}}
-
-% Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
-% From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
-% He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
-\def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
- \textleading = 12.5pt
- %
- \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
- {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
- {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
- {210mm}{148mm}%
- %
- \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
- \tolerance = 800
- \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \defbodyindent = 2mm
- \tableindent = 12mm
-}}
-
-% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
-\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
- \afourpaper
- \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
- {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
- {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
- {297mm}{210mm}%
- %
- % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
- \globaldefs = 0
-}}
-
-% Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
-\def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
- \afourpaper
- \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
- {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
- {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
- {297mm}{210mm}%
- \globaldefs = 0
-}}
-
-% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
-% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
-% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
-%
-\parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
-\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
- \globaldefs = 1
- %
- \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- \setleading{\textleading}%
- %
- \dimen0 = #1\relax
- \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
- \advance\dimen0 by 1in % reference point for DVI is 1 inch from top of page
- %
- \dimen2 = \hsize
- \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
- \advance\dimen2 by 1in % reference point is 1 inch from left edge of page
- %
- \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
- {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
- {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
- {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
-}}
-
-% Set default to letter.
-%
-\letterpaper
-
-% Default value of \hfuzz, for suppressing warnings about overfull hboxes.
-\hfuzz = 1pt
-
-
-\message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
-
-\def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
-
-% DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
-\catcode`\^^? = 14
-
-% Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
-\catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"}
-\catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
-\catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+}
-\catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<}
-\catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>}
-\catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^}
-\catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_}
-\catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|}
-\catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~}
-
-% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
-% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
-% where something hairier probably needs to be done.
-%
-% #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
-% otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
-% interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
-% typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
-%
-\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
-
-% Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
-% non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
-% italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
-% this is not a problem.
-\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
-
-% Set catcodes for Texinfo file
-
-% Active characters for printing the wanted glyph.
-% Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
-% use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
-%
-\catcode`\"=\active
-\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
-\let"=\activedoublequote
-\catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde
-\chardef\hatchar=`\^
-\catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hatchar}} \let^ = \activehat
-
-\catcode`\_=\active
-\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
-\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
-\let\realunder=_
-
-\catcode`\|=\active \def|{{\tt\char124}}
-
-\chardef \less=`\<
-\catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless
-\chardef \gtr=`\>
-\catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr
-\catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
-\catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
-\catcode`\-=\active \let-=\normaldash
-
-
-% used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
-% breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
-\def\texinfochars{%
- \let< = \activeless
- \let> = \activegtr
- \let~ = \activetilde
- \let^ = \activehat
- \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
- \let\b = \strong
- \let\i = \smartitalic
- % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
-}
-
-% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
-% parsing them.
-\def\turnoffactive{%
- \normalturnoffactive
- \otherbackslash
-}
-
-\catcode`\@=0
-
-% \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
-% as in \char`\\.
-\global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
-
-% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other.
-{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\}}
-
-% In Texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
-% in fixed width font.
-\catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on.
-
-% Print a typewriter backslash. For math mode, we can't simply use
-% \backslashcurfont: the story here is that in math mode, the \char
-% of \backslashcurfont ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol
-% font (because \char in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex
-% sets \mathcode`\\="026E). Hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
-% which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
-% ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
-% usual hex value because it has already been made active.
-
-@def@ttbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}}
-@let@backslashchar = @ttbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
-
-% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
-% catcode other.
-@gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
-
-% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
-% the literal character `\'.
-%
-{@catcode`- = @active
- @gdef@normalturnoffactive{%
- @passthroughcharstrue
- @let-=@normaldash
- @let"=@normaldoublequote
- @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
- @let+=@normalplus
- @let<=@normalless
- @let>=@normalgreater
- @let^=@normalcaret
- @let_=@normalunderscore
- @let|=@normalverticalbar
- @let~=@normaltilde
- @let\=@ttbackslash
- @markupsetuplqdefault
- @markupsetuprqdefault
- @unsepspaces
- }
-}
-
-% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
-% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
-% So turn them off again, and have @fixbackslash turn them back on.
-@catcode`+=@other @catcode`@_=@other
-
-% \enablebackslashhack - allow file to begin `\input texinfo'
-%
-% If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
-% That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
-% a backslash.
-% If the file did not have a `\input texinfo', then it is turned off after
-% the first line; otherwise the first `\' in the file would cause an error.
-% This is used on the very last line of this file, texinfo.tex.
-% We also use @c to call @fixbackslash, in case ends of lines are hidden.
-{
-@catcode`@^=7
-@catcode`@^^M=13@gdef@enablebackslashhack{%
- @global@let\ = @eatinput%
- @catcode`@^^M=13%
- @def@c{@fixbackslash@c}%
- % Definition for the newline at the end of this file.
- @def ^^M{@let^^M@secondlinenl}%
- % Definition for a newline in the main Texinfo file.
- @gdef @secondlinenl{@fixbackslash}%
- % In case the first line has a whole-line command on it
- @let@originalparsearg@parsearg
- @def@parsearg{@fixbackslash@originalparsearg}
-}}
-
-{@catcode`@^=7 @catcode`@^^M=13%
-@gdef@eatinput input texinfo#1^^M{@fixbackslash}}
-
-% Emergency active definition of newline, in case an active newline token
-% appears by mistake.
-{@catcode`@^=7 @catcode13=13%
-@gdef@enableemergencynewline{%
- @gdef^^M{%
- @par%
- %<warning: active newline>@par%
-}}}
-
-
-@gdef@fixbackslash{%
- @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @ttbackslash @fi
- @catcode13=5 % regular end of line
- @enableemergencynewline
- @let@c=@comment
- @let@parsearg@originalparsearg
- % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
- % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
- @catcode`+=@active
- @catcode`@_=@active
- %
- % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
- % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. This macro, @fixbackslash, gets
- % called at the beginning of every Texinfo file. Not opening texinfo.cnf
- % directly in this file, texinfo.tex, makes it possible to make a format
- % file for Texinfo.
- %
- @openin 1 texinfo.cnf
- @ifeof 1 @else @input texinfo.cnf @fi
- @closein 1
-}
-
-
-% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
-@escapechar = `@@
-
-% These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
-% active definitions as the normal characters.
-@def@normaldot{.}
-@def@normalquest{?}
-@def@normalslash{/}
-
-% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
-% @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
-@catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&}
-@catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#}
-@catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
-
-@let @hashchar = @normalhash
-
-@c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
-@c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
-@c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
-@c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
-@catcode`@'=@active
-@catcode`@`=@active
-@markupsetuplqdefault
-@markupsetuprqdefault
-
-@c Local variables:
-@c eval: (add-hook 'before-save-hook 'time-stamp)
-@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message\\|emacs-page"
-@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
-@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-@c time-stamp-end: "}"
-@c End:
-
-@c vim:sw=2:
-
-@enablebackslashhack
diff --git a/build-aux/ylwrap b/build-aux/ylwrap
index d1533360..e8ec109f 100755
--- a/build-aux/ylwrap
+++ b/build-aux/ylwrap
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
scriptversion=2018-03-07.03; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 1996-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
#
# Written by Tom Tromey <tromey@cygnus.com>.
#